Canon Zoom 8-3 User guide
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
Camera User Guide
●● Make sure you read this guide, including the “Safety Precautions”
(= 14) section, before using the camera.
●● Reading this guide will help you learn to use the camera properly.
●● Store this guide safely so that you can use it in the future.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
ENGLISH
●● Click the buttons in the lower right to access other pages.
: Next page
: Previous page
: Page before you clicked a link
●● To jump to the beginning of a chapter, click the chapter title at right.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
©CANON INC. 2014
CDD-E598-010
1
Before Use
Compatible Memory Cards
The following memory cards (sold separately) can be used, regardless of
capacity.
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
●● SD memory cards*1
Initial Information
●● SDXC memory cards* *
1 2
Package Contents
Before use, make sure the following items are included in the package.
If anything is missing, contact your camera retailer.
Camera
Battery Pack
NB-10L
(with terminal cover)
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● SDHC memory cards *1*2
*1 Cards conforming to SD standards. However, not all memory cards have been
verified to work with the camera.
*2 UHS-I memory cards are also supported.
Battery Charger
CB-2LC/CB-2LCE
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
Neck Strap
Lens Cap
(with cord)
●● Printed matter is also included.
●● A memory card is not included (= 2).
2
Preliminary Notes and Legal
Information
●● Take and review some test shots initially to make sure the images
were recorded correctly. Please note that Canon Inc., its subsidiaries
and affiliates, and its distributors are not liable for any consequential
damages arising from any malfunction of a camera or accessory,
including memory cards, that result in the failure of an image to be
recorded or to be recorded in a way that is machine readable.
●● Images recorded by the camera shall be for personal use. Refrain
from unauthorized recording that infringes on copyright law, and note
that even for personal use, photography may contravene copyright
or other legal rights at some performances or exhibitions, or in some
commercial settings.
Part Names and Conventions in This
Guide
●● The LCD monitor may be covered with a thin plastic film for protection
against scratches during shipment. If covered, remove the film before
using the camera.
●● When the camera is used over an extended period, it may become
warm. This does not indicate damage.
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
(1) (2) (3) (4)(5)
(6)
(7) (8)
(3) (9) (10)
(17)
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
(18)(19) (20)
(14)
(15)
(16)
(11)
●● The camera warranty is valid only in the area of purchase. In case of
camera problems while abroad, return to the area of purchase before
contacting a Canon Customer Support Help Desk.
●● Although the LCD monitor and viewfinder are produced under
extremely high-precision manufacturing conditions and more than
99.99% of the pixels meet design specifications, in rare cases some
pixels may be defective or may appear as red or black dots. This does
not indicate camera damage or affect recorded images.
Before Use
(12)
(13)
(1)
Zoom lever
Shooting: ‌[
[
Playback:‌ [
[
(2)
Shutter button
(3)
Strap mount
(4)
Front dial
(5)
Mode dial
(10) External microphone IN terminal
(telephoto)] /
(wide angle)]
(magnify)] /
(index)]
(6)Flash
(7)Microphone
(8)Lamp
(9)Speaker
(11) Focal length markings (approx.)
(12)Lens
(13) Lens hood/filter adapter mount
(Framing Assist – Seek)]
(14)[
button
(15)
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
(N-Mark)*
(Framing Assist – Lock)]
(16)[
button
(17) Tripod socket
(18) Lock release switch
(19) Memory card/battery cover
(20) DC coupler cable port
* Used with NFC features (= 123).
3
(4) (5)
(6) (7) (8)
(9)
(13)
(3)
(14)
(15)
(2)
(16)
(17)
(18)
(1)
(19)
●● In this guide, icons are used to represent the corresponding camera
buttons and dials on which they appear or which they resemble.
Before Use
●● The following camera buttons and controls are represented by icons.
] Front dial (4) on front
[ ] Right button (18) on back
[
[ ] Up button (16) on back
[ ] Down button (19) on back
[ ] Left button (22) on back
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● Shooting modes and on-screen icons and text are indicated in
brackets.
●●
: Important information you should know
●●
: Notes and tips for expert camera use
●● =xx: Pages with related information (in this example, “xx” represents
a page number)
●● Instructions in this guide apply to the camera under default settings.
(10)(11)
(22) (21) (20)
(12)
(1)
Screen (LCD monitor)
(14) Movie button
(2)
Wi-Fi antenna area
(15)[
(3)
Diopter adjustment dial
(4)Viewfinder
(Wi‑Fi)] / [
(16)[
Up button
(5)
Hot shoe
(17) FUNC./SET button
(6)
Power button
(18)[ (Flash)] / Right button
(7)[
(Shortcut)] button
(19)[
(AF frame selector)] button
(Display)] / Down button
] button
Remote terminal
(20)[
(9)
AV OUT (Audio/video output) /
DIGITAL terminal
(21)[ (Mobile Device Connection)]
button
(11)[
(Playback)] button
●● The symbols “  Still Images” and “  Movies” below titles indicate
how the function is used—whether for still images or movies.
(Single shot)] /
(8)
(10)Indicator
●● For convenience, all supported memory cards are simply referred to as
the “memory card”.
(22)[ (Macro)] / [
/ Left button
(Manual focus)]
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
(12)HDMITM terminal
(13)[
[
(Exposure compensation)] /
(Single-image erase)] button
4
Table of Contents
Before Use
Advanced Guide
1 Camera Basics............................................................ 25
Package Contents..................................................................... 2
Compatible Memory Cards....................................................... 2
Shutter Button......................................................................... 26
Preliminary Notes and Legal Information.................................. 3
Viewfinder................................................................................ 27
Part Names and Conventions in This Guide............................. 3
Shooting Modes...................................................................... 27
Common Camera Operations................................................. 12
Shooting Display Options........................................................ 28
Safety Precautions.................................................................. 14
Using the FUNC. Menu........................................................... 29
Basic Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
On-Screen Keyboard.............................................................. 31
Indicator Display...................................................................... 32
Initial Preparations.................................................................. 17
Clock....................................................................................... 32
Attaching Accessories................................................................17
Holding the Camera....................................................................18
Charging the Battery Pack..........................................................18
Inserting the Battery Pack and Memory Card.............................19
Using the Screen........................................................................20
Adjusting the Screen Angle and Orientation...........................20
Setting the Date and Time..........................................................20
Changing the Date and Time..................................................21
Display Language.......................................................................21
2 Auto Mode / Hybrid Auto Mode................................. 33
Shooting (Smart Auto)................................................................22
Viewing.......................................................................................24
Erasing Images......................................................................24
Advanced Guide
Using the Menu Screen........................................................... 30
Basic Operations............................................................. 17
Trying the Camera Out............................................................ 22
Basic Guide
On/Off...................................................................................... 25
Power-Saving Features (Auto Power Down)..............................26
Power Saving in Shooting Mode............................................26
Power Saving in Playback Mode............................................26
Initial Information............................................................... 2
Before Use
Shooting with Camera-Determined Settings........................... 33
Shooting (Smart Auto)................................................................33
Shooting in Hybrid Auto Mode....................................................35
Digest Movie Playback...........................................................36
Still Images/Movies................................................................36
Still Images.............................................................................36
Movies....................................................................................37
Scene Icons................................................................................37
Continuous Shooting Scenes.................................................38
Image Stabilization Icons............................................................39
On-Screen Frames.....................................................................39
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
Common, Convenient Features.............................................. 40
Zooming In Closer on Subjects (Digital Zoom)...........................40
5
Easily Reacquiring Subjects after Manual Zooming
(Framing Assist – Seek).............................................................40
Easily Composing Shots after Manual Zooming
(Framing Assist – Lock)..............................................................41
Auto Zooming to Keep Faces at a Constant Size.......................42
Adjusting the Constant Face Display Size.............................42
Easily Reacquiring Subjects with Auto Zooming
(Seek Assist)...............................................................................43
Using the Self-Timer...................................................................44
Using the Self-Timer to Avoid Camera Shake........................44
Customizing the Self-Timer....................................................44
Adding a Date Stamp.................................................................45
Continuous Shooting..................................................................46
Image Display during Playback..............................................46
Checking for Closed Eyes..........................................................55
Customizing Camera Operation.............................................. 55
Deactivating the AF-Assist Beam...............................................55
Deactivating the Red-Eye Reduction Lamp................................55
Changing the Image Display Style after Shots...........................56
Changing the Image Display Period after Shots....................56
Changing the Screen Displayed after Shots..........................56
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Enjoying a Variety of Images from Each Shot
(Creative Shot)........................................................................ 57
Choosing Effects........................................................................58
Moving Subjects (Sports)........................................................ 58
Specific Scenes....................................................................... 59
Image Effects (Creative Filters)............................................... 60
Personal Information..................................................................47
Registering Face ID Information.................................................47
Shooting.....................................................................................48
Checking and Editing Registered Information............................49
Overwriting and Adding Face Information..............................50
Erasing Registered Information..............................................51
Shooting High-Contrast Scenes (High Dynamic Range)............61
Adding Artistic Effects.............................................................61
Shooting with a Fish-Eye Lens Effect (Fish-Eye Effect).............62
Shots Resembling Miniature Models (Miniature Effect)..............62
Playback Speed and Estimated Playback Time
(for One-Minute Clips)............................................................63
Shooting with a Toy Camera Effect (Toy Camera Effect)............63
Shooting with a Soft Focus Effect...............................................64
Shooting in Monochrome............................................................64
Changing the Aspect Ratio.........................................................51
Changing Image Resolution (Size).............................................52
Guidelines for Choosing Resolution Based on Paper Size
(for 4:3 Images)......................................................................52
Red-Eye Correction....................................................................52
Correcting Greenish Image Areas from Mercury Lamps............53
Changing Movie Image Quality..................................................53
Basic Guide
3 Other Shooting Modes............................................... 57
Using Face ID......................................................................... 47
Image Customization Features............................................... 51
Before Use
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
Special Modes for Other Purposes......................................... 65
Auto Shooting after Face Detection (Smart Shutter)..................65
Auto Shooting after Smile Detection......................................65
Using the Wink Self-Timer......................................................65
Using the Face Self-Timer......................................................66
Helpful Shooting Features....................................................... 54
Shooting Various Movies......................................................... 67
Using the Electronic Level..........................................................54
Magnifying the Area in Focus.....................................................54
Shooting Movies in Movie Mode.................................................67
Locking or Changing Image Brightness before Shooting.......68
6
Sound Settings...........................................................................68
Adjusting the Recording Volume............................................68
Deactivating the Wind Filter...................................................69
Using the Attenuator...............................................................69
Shooting iFrame Movies.............................................................69
Shooting Super Slow Motion Movies..........................................70
4 P Mode......................................................................... 71
Shooting in Program AE ([P] Mode)........................................ 71
Image Brightness (Exposure).................................................. 72
Adjusting Image Brightness (Exposure Compensation).............72
Locking Image Brightness / Exposure (AE Lock).......................72
Changing the Metering Method..................................................72
Linking the Spot AE Point Frame to the AF Frame.................73
Changing the ISO Speed............................................................73
Adjusting ISO Auto Settings...................................................74
Changing the Noise Reduction Level (High ISO NR).................74
Auto Exposure Bracketing (AEB Shooting)................................74
Correcting Image Brightness (i-Contrast)...................................75
Dynamic Range Correction (DR Correction)..........................75
Shadow Correct......................................................................76
Image Colors........................................................................... 76
Adjusting White Balance.............................................................76
Custom White Balance...........................................................77
Manually Correcting White Balance.......................................77
Changing Image Color Tones (My Colors).................................77
Custom Color.........................................................................78
Shooting Range and Focusing................................................ 79
Shooting Close-Ups (Macro)......................................................79
Shooting in Manual Focus Mode................................................79
Easily Identifying the Focus Area (MF Peaking).....................80
Focus Bracketing (Focus-BKT Mode)....................................80
Storing the Zoom or Focal Position............................................81
Storing the Zoom Position......................................................81
Storing the Focal Position......................................................81
Digital Tele-Converter.................................................................81
Changing the AF Frame Mode...................................................82
FlexiZone/Center....................................................................82
Moving and Resizing AF Frames (FlexiZone)........................82
Face Detect............................................................................83
Choosing Subjects to Focus On (Tracking AF)......................83
Shooting with Servo AF..........................................................84
Changing the Focus Setting.......................................................84
Choosing a Person to Focus On (Face Select)..........................85
Shooting with the AF Lock..........................................................85
Shooting Continuously as the Camera Keeps the Subject
in Focus......................................................................................86
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Flash....................................................................................... 86
Changing the Flash Mode..........................................................86
Auto........................................................................................86
On...........................................................................................86
Slow Synchro.........................................................................87
Off...........................................................................................87
Adjusting the Flash Exposure Compensation.............................87
Shooting with the FE Lock..........................................................88
Changing the Flash Timing.........................................................88
Shooting RAW Images............................................................ 89
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
Other Settings......................................................................... 90
Changing the Compression Ratio (Image Quality).....................90
Changing the IS Mode Settings..................................................90
Shooting Movies with Subjects at the Same Size Shown
before Shooting......................................................................91
7
5 Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode....................................... 92
Viewing Individual Images in a Group......................................107
Specific Shutter Speeds ([Tv] Mode)...................................... 92
Editing Face ID Information................................................... 107
Specific Aperture Values ([Av] Mode)...................................... 93
Changing Names......................................................................107
Erasing Names.........................................................................108
Specific Shutter Speeds and Aperture Values ([M] Mode)...... 93
Adjusting the Flash Output.........................................................94
Recording Movies at Specific Shutter Speeds and Aperture
Values.........................................................................................95
Changing Settings during Recording......................................95
Customization for Shooting Styles.......................................... 96
Customizing Display Information................................................96
Assigning Functions to Buttons..................................................96
Customizing the FUNC. Menu (FUNC. Menu Layout)............ 97
Choosing Items to Include in the Menu......................................97
Rearranging Menu Items........................................................98
Saving Shooting Settings...........................................................98
Settings that can be saved.....................................................98
Saving Commonly Used Shooting Menu Items (My Menu)........99
6 Playback Mode......................................................... 101
Viewing.................................................................................. 101
Switching Display Modes..........................................................102
Overexposure Warning (for Image Highlights).....................103
Histogram.............................................................................103
RGB Histogram, GPS Information Display...........................103
Viewing Short Movies Created When Shooting Still Images
(Digest Movies).........................................................................104
Viewing by Date....................................................................104
Checking People Detected in Face ID......................................104
Browsing and Filtering Images.............................................. 105
Navigating through Images in an Index....................................105
Finding Images Matching Specified Conditions........................105
Using the Front Dial to Jump between Images.........................106
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
Image Viewing Options......................................................... 108
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Magnifying Images...................................................................108
Viewing Slideshows..................................................................109
Changing Slideshow Settings...............................................109
Auto Playback of Related Images (Smart Shuffle)................... 110
Protecting Images..................................................................110
Choosing a Selection Method................................................... 110
Choosing Images Individually................................................... 111
Selecting a Range.................................................................... 111
Protecting All Images at Once.................................................. 112
Clearing All Protection at Once............................................ 112
Erasing Images......................................................................112
Erasing Multiple Images at Once.............................................. 113
Choosing a Selection Method.............................................. 113
Choosing Images Individually............................................... 113
Selecting a Range................................................................ 113
Specifying All Images at Once.............................................. 114
Rotating Images.....................................................................114
Deactivating Auto Rotation....................................................... 115
Tagging Images as Favorites.................................................115
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
Editing Still Images.................................................................116
Resizing Images....................................................................... 116
Cropping................................................................................... 117
Changing Image Color Tones (My Colors)............................... 118
Correcting Image Brightness (i-Contrast)................................. 118
Correcting Red-Eye.................................................................. 119
8
Editing Movies....................................................................... 120
Adding Comments....................................................................139
Reducing File Sizes..................................................................121
Editing Digest Movies...............................................................121
Sending Images Automatically (Image Sync)........................ 139
7 Wi-Fi Functions........................................................ 122
Available Wi-Fi Features....................................................... 122
Sending Images to a Smartphone......................................... 123
Sending to a Smartphone Assigned to the Button....................123
Adding a Smartphone Using the Wi-Fi Menu...........................125
Using Another Access Point.....................................................126
Previous Access Points............................................................127
Saving Images to a Computer............................................... 127
Preparing to Register a Computer............................................127
Checking Your Computer Environment................................127
Installing the Software..........................................................127
Configuring the Computer for a Wi-Fi Connection
(Windows Only)....................................................................129
Saving Images to a Connected Computer................................129
Confirming Access Point Compatibility.................................129
Using WPS-Compatible Access Points................................130
Connecting to Listed Access Points.....................................132
Previous Access Points........................................................132
Sending Images to a Registered Web Service...................... 133
Registering Web Services........................................................133
Registering CANON iMAGE GATEWAY...............................133
Registering Other Web Services..........................................135
Uploading Images to Web Services.........................................135
Printing Images Wirelessly from a Connected Printer........... 136
Sending Images to Another Camera..................................... 137
Image Sending Options......................................................... 138
Notes on Sending Images........................................................138
Choosing the Image Resolution (Size).....................................139
Initial Preparations....................................................................139
Preparing the Camera..........................................................139
Preparing the Computer.......................................................140
Sending Images........................................................................140
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Using a Smartphone to View Camera Images and Control
the Camera........................................................................... 141
Geotagging Images on the Camera.........................................141
Shooting Remotely...................................................................142
Editing or Erasing Wi-Fi Settings.......................................... 143
Editing Connection Information................................................143
Changing a Device Nickname..............................................143
Erasing Connection Information...........................................143
Returning the Wi-Fi Settings to Default....................................144
8 Setting Menu............................................................. 145
Adjusting Basic Camera Functions....................................... 145
Silencing Camera Operations...................................................145
Adjusting the Volume................................................................145
Hiding Hints and Tips................................................................146
Date and Time..........................................................................146
World Clock..............................................................................146
Lens Retraction Timing.............................................................147
Using Eco Mode.......................................................................147
Power-Saving Adjustment........................................................147
Screen Brightness....................................................................148
Hiding the Start-Up Screen.......................................................148
Formatting Memory Cards........................................................148
Low-Level Formatting...........................................................149
File Numbering.........................................................................149
Date-Based Image Storage......................................................150
Metric / Non-Metric Display......................................................150
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
9
Electronic Level Calibration......................................................150
Resetting the Electronic Level..............................................150
Setting Copyright Information to Record in Images..................151
Deleting All Copyright Information........................................151
Checking Certification Logos....................................................151
Display Language.....................................................................152
Adjusting Other Settings...........................................................152
Restoring Defaults....................................................................152
9Accessories.............................................................. 153
System Map.......................................................................... 154
Optional Accessories............................................................. 155
Power Supplies.........................................................................155
Flash Units................................................................................155
Other Accessories....................................................................155
Printers.....................................................................................156
Using Optional Accessories.................................................. 157
Playback on a TV.....................................................................157
Playback on a High-Definition TV.........................................157
Playback on a Standard-Definition TV.................................158
Powering the Camera with Household Power..........................158
Using an External Microphone.................................................159
Using a Lens Hood (Sold Separately)......................................160
Using Lens Filters (Sold Separately)........................................160
Using a Remote Switch (Sold Separately)...............................161
Using an External Flash (Sold Separately)...............................161
Speedlite EX Series.............................................................161
Using Speedlite Bracket SB-E2 (Sold Separately)...............162
Camera Settings Available with an External Flash
(Sold Separately)..................................................................163
Using the Software................................................................ 164
Software...................................................................................164
Software Instruction Manual.................................................164
Computer Connections via a Cable..........................................164
Checking Your Computer Environment................................164
Installing the Software..........................................................164
Saving Images to a Computer..................................................165
Printing Images..................................................................... 166
Easy Print.................................................................................166
Configuring Print Settings.........................................................167
Cropping Images before Printing..........................................168
Choosing Paper Size and Layout before Printing................168
Available Layout Options......................................................169
Printing ID Photos................................................................169
Printing Movie Scenes..............................................................169
Movie Printing Options.........................................................169
Adding Images to the Print List (DPOF)...................................170
Configuring Print Settings.....................................................170
Setting Up Printing for Individual Images.............................171
Setting Up Printing for a Range of Images...........................171
Setting Up Printing for All Images.........................................171
Clearing All Images from the Print List.................................171
Printing Images Added to the Print List (DPOF)...................172
Adding Images to a Photobook................................................172
Choosing a Selection Method..............................................172
Adding Images Individually...................................................172
Adding All Images to a Photobook.......................................173
Removing All Images from a Photobook..............................173
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
10Appendix................................................................... 174
Troubleshooting..................................................................... 174
On-Screen Messages........................................................... 178
On-Screen Information.......................................................... 180
Shooting (Information Display).................................................180
Battery Level........................................................................180
10
Playback (Detailed Information Display)...................................181
Summary of Movie Control Panel.........................................182
Functions and Menu Tables.................................................. 182
Functions Available in Each Shooting Mode............................182
FUNC. Menu.............................................................................184
Shooting Tab.............................................................................187
Set Up Tab................................................................................194
My Menu Tab............................................................................194
Playback Tab............................................................................194
Print Tab...................................................................................195
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Handling Precautions............................................................ 195
Specifications........................................................................ 196
Camera Specifications..............................................................196
Wi-Fi.....................................................................................196
Digital Zoom Focal Length (35mm equivalent).....................196
Number of Shots/Recording Time, Playback Time...............197
Number of Shots per Memory Card.....................................197
Recording Time per Memory Card.......................................198
Flash Range.........................................................................198
Shooting Range....................................................................198
Continuous Shooting Speed.................................................198
Shutter Speed......................................................................199
Aperture................................................................................199
Battery Pack NB-10L............................................................199
Battery Charger CB-2LC/CB-2LCE......................................199
Lens Hood LH-DC90............................................................199
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
Index..................................................................................... 200
Wi-Fi (Wireless LAN) Precautions......................................... 202
Radio Wave Interference Precautions......................................202
Security Precautions.................................................................202
Trademarks and Licensing...................................................203
Disclaimer.............................................................................203
11
Common Camera Operations
Before Use
Applying special effects
Basic Guide
Vivid Colors
(= 60)
Shoot
Poster Effect
(= 60)
Fish-Eye Effect
(= 62)
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● Use camera-determined settings (Auto Mode, Hybrid Auto Mode)
-- = 33, = 35
●● See several effects applied to each shot, using camera-determined
settings (Creative Shot Mode)
-- = 57
Shooting people well
Portraits
(= 59)
Fireworks
(= 59)
Toy Camera Effect
(= 63)
Soft Focus
(= 64)
Monochrome
(= 64)
●● Focus on faces
-- = 33, = 59, = 83, = 85
Against Snow
(= 59)
●● Without using the flash (Flash Off)
-- = 33
Matching specific scenes
Sports
(= 58)
Miniature Effect
(= 62)
●● Include yourself in the shot (Self-Timer)
-- = 44, = 66
Night Scenes
(= 59)
Low Light
(= 59)
●● Add a date stamp
-- = 45
●● Use Face ID
-- = 47, = 104
●● Movie clips and photos together (Movie Digest)
-- = 35
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
12
View
Save
Before Use
●● View images (Playback Mode)
-- = 101
●● Save images to a computer via a cable
-- = 165
Basic Guide
●● Automatic playback (Slideshow)
-- = 109
●● Save images to a computer
-- = 165
Advanced Guide
●● On a TV
-- = 157
●● On a computer
-- = 164
●● Browse through images quickly
-- = 105
●● Erase images
-- = 112
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Use Wi-Fi Functions
●● Send images to a smartphone
-- = 123
●● Share images online
-- = 133
●● Send images to a computer
-- = 127
Shoot/View Movies
●● Shoot movies
-- = 33, = 67
●● View movies (Playback Mode)
-- = 101
●● Fast-moving subjects, slow-motion playback
-- = 70
Print
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● Print pictures
-- = 166
13
Safety Precautions
●● Before using the product, ensure that you read the safety precautions
described below. Always ensure that the product is used correctly.
●● The safety precautions noted here are intended to prevent you and
other persons from being injured or incurring property damage.
●● Be sure to also check the guides included with any separately sold
accessories you use.
Warning
Denotes the possibility of serious injury or death.
●● Do not trigger the flash in close proximity to people’s eyes.
Exposure to the intense light produced by the flash could damage
eyesight. In particular, remain at least 1 meter (3.3 feet) away from infants
when using the flash.
●● Store this equipment out of the reach of children and infants.
A strap wound around a child’s neck may result in asphyxiation.
If your product uses a power cord, mistakenly winding the cord around a
child’s neck may result in asphyxiation.
●● Use only recommended power sources.
●● Do not disassemble, alter, or apply heat to the product.
●● Do not peel off the label, if the battery pack has one.
●● Avoid dropping or subjecting the product to severe impacts.
●● Do not touch the interior of the product if it is broken, such as when
dropped.
●● Stop using the product immediately if it emits smoke or a strange
smell, or otherwise behaves abnormally.
●● Do not use organic solvents such as alcohol, benzine, or thinner to
clean the product.
●● Avoid contact with liquid, and do not allow liquid or foreign objects
inside.
This could result in electrical shock or fire.
If the product gets wet, or if liquid or foreign objects get inside, remove the
battery pack/batteries or unplug immediately.
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
●● Do not look through the viewfinder (if your model has one) at intense
light sources, such as the sun on a clear day or an intense artificial
light source.
This could damage your eyesight.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● Do not touch the product during thunderstorms if it is plugged in.
This could result in electrical shock or fire. Immediately stop using the
product and distance yourself from it.
●● Use only the recommended battery pack/batteries.
●● Do not place the battery pack/batteries near or in direct flame.
This may cause the battery pack/batteries to explode or leak, resulting in
electrical shock, fire, or injuries. If leaking battery electrolyte comes into
contact with eyes, mouth, skin, or clothing, immediately flush with water.
●● If the product uses a battery charger, note the following precautions.
-- Remove the plug periodically and, using a dry cloth, wipe away any
dust and dirt that has collected on the plug, the exterior of the power
outlet, and the surrounding area.
-- Do not insert or remove the plug with wet hands.
-- Do not use the equipment in a manner that exceeds the rated
capacity of the electrical outlet or wiring accessories. Do not use if
the plug is damaged or not fully inserted in the outlet.
-- Do not allow dust or metal objects (such as pins or keys) to contact
the terminals or plug.
-- Do not cut, damage, alter, or place heavy items on the power cord, if
your product uses one.
This could result in electrical shock or fire.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
14
●● Turn the camera off in places where camera use is prohibited.
The electromagnetic waves emitted by the camera may interfere with the
operation of electronic instruments and other devices. Exercise adequate
caution when using the product in places where use of electronic devices
is restricted, such as inside airplanes and medical facilities.
●● On products that raise and lower the flash automatically, make sure to
avoid pinching your fingers with the lowering flash.
This could result in injury.
Denotes the possibility of injury.
●● When carrying the product by the strap, be careful not to bang it,
subject it to strong impacts or shocks, or let it get caught on other
objects.
●● Be careful not to bump or push strongly on the lens.
This could lead to injury or damage the camera.
●● Be careful not to subject the screen to strong impacts.
If the screen cracks, injury may result from the broken fragments.
●● When using the flash, be careful not to cover it with your fingers or
clothing.
This could result in burns or damage to the flash.
●● Avoid using, placing, or storing the product in the following places:
-- Places subject to direct sunlight
-- Places subject to temperatures above 40 °C (104 °F)
-- Humid or dusty places
These could cause leakage, overheating, or an explosion of the battery
pack/batteries, resulting in electrical shock, fire, burns, or other injuries.
Overheating and damage may result in electrical shock, fire, burns, or
other injuries.
●● The slideshow transition effects may cause discomfort when viewed
for prolonged periods.
●● When using optional lenses, lens filters, or filter adapters (if
applicable), be sure to attach these accessories firmly.
If the lens accessory becomes loose and falls off, it may crack, and the
shards of glass may lead to cuts.
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
Caution
Caution
Before Use
Denotes the possibility of property damage.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● Do not aim the camera at intense light sources, such as the sun on a
clear day or an intense artificial light source.
Doing so may damage the image sensor or other internal components.
●● When using the camera on a sandy beach or at a windy location, be
careful not to allow dust or sand to enter the camera.
●● On products that raise and lower the flash automatically, do not push
the flash down or pry it open.
This may cause the product to malfunction.
●● Wipe off any dust, grime, or other foreign matter on the flash with a
cotton swab or cloth.
The heat emitted from the flash may cause foreign matter to smoke or the
product to malfunction.
●● Remove and store the battery pack/batteries when you are not using
the product.
Any battery leakage that occurs may cause product damage.
●● Before you discard the battery pack/batteries, cover the terminals with
tape or other insulators.
Contacting other metal materials may lead to fire or explosions.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● Unplug any battery charger used with the product when not in use. Do
not cover with a cloth or other objects when in use.
Leaving the unit plugged in for a long period of time may cause it to
overheat and distort, resulting in fire.
15
●● Do not leave any dedicated battery packs near pets.
Pets biting the battery pack could cause leakage, overheating, or
explosion, resulting in product damage or fire.
●● If your product uses multiple batteries, do not use batteries that
have different levels of charge together, and do not use old and
new batteries together. Do not insert the batteries with the + and –
terminals reversed.
This may cause the product to malfunction.
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● Do not sit down with the camera in your pant pocket.
Doing so may cause malfunctions or damage the screen.
●● When putting the camera in your bag, ensure that hard objects do not
come into contact with the screen. Also close the screen (so that it
faces the body), if your product’s screen closes.
●● Do not attach any hard objects to the product.
Doing so may cause malfunctions or damage the screen.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
16
Basic Guide
Initial Preparations
Before Use
Basic Guide
Prepare for shooting as follows.
Advanced Guide
Attaching Accessories
Basic Operations
1 Attach the strap.
(5 )
(4)
Basic information and instructions, from initial preparations to shooting
and playback
(1)
(1)
(2)
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
(3)
(2)
●● Attach the included strap to the camera
as shown.
●● On the other side of the camera, attach
the strap the same way.
2 Attach the lens cap.
●● Remove the lens cap from the lens and
attach the lens cap cord to the strap.
(1)
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
17
2 Charge the battery pack.
(2)
●● Always remove the lens cap before
turning the camera on. Try clipping the
lens cap to the neck strap when the cap
is not in use.
(1)
CB-2LC
●● Keep the lens cap on the lens when the
camera is not in use.
CB-2LCE
●● Place the strap around your neck.
●● When shooting, keep your arms close to
your body and hold the camera securely
to prevent it from moving. If you have
raised the flash, do not rest your fingers
on it.
Charging the Battery Pack
Before use, charge the battery pack with the included charger. Be sure to
charge the battery pack initially, because the camera is not sold with the
battery pack charged.
1 Insert the battery pack.
(2)
●● CB-2LCE: Plug the power cord into the
charger, then plug the other end into a
power outlet.
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● The charging lamp turns orange, and
charging begins.
Holding the Camera
(1)
●● CB-2LC: Flip out the plug (1) and plug the
charger into a power outlet (2).
●● Remove the cover from the battery pack,
align the
marks on the battery pack
and charger, and insert the battery pack
by pushing it in (1) and down (2).
(1 )
●● When charging is finished, the lamp turns
green.
3 Remove the battery pack.
●● After unplugging the battery charger,
remove the battery pack by pushing it in
(1) and up (2).
(2)
●● To protect the battery pack and keep it in optimal condition, do not
charge it continuously for more than 24 hours.
●● For battery chargers that use a power cord, do not attach
the charger or cord to other objects. Doing so could result in
malfunction or damage to the product.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
18
●● For details on charging time and the number of shots and
recording time possible with a fully charged battery pack, see
“Number of Shots/Recording Time, Playback Time” (= 197).
●● Charged battery packs gradually lose their charge, even when
they are not used. Charge the battery pack on (or immediately
before) the day of use.
●● As a visual reminder of the charge status, attach the battery cover
visible on a charged battery pack and concealed on an
with
uncharged one.
●● The charger can be used in areas with 100 – 240 V AC power
(50/60 Hz). For power outlets in a different format, use a
commercially available adapter for the plug. Never use an
electrical transformer designed for traveling, which may damage
the battery pack.
2 Insert the battery pack.
(2)
(1)
(2)
(1)
1 Open the cover.
●● Slide the switch (1) and open the cover
(2).
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● If you insert the battery pack facing the
wrong way, it cannot be locked into the
correct position. Always confirm that the
battery pack is facing the right way and
locks when inserted.
3
Check the card’s write-protect tab
and insert the memory card.
●● Recording is not possible on memory
cards with a write-protect tab when the
tab is in the locked position. Slide the tab
to the unlocked position.
Inserting the Battery Pack and Memory Card
Insert the included battery pack and a memory card (sold separately).
Note that before using a new memory card (or a memory card formatted
in another device), you should format the memory card with this camera
(= 148).
●● Holding the battery pack with the
terminals (1) facing as shown, press the
battery lock (2) in the direction of the
arrow and insert the battery pack until the
lock clicks shut.
(1)
●● Insert the memory card with the label (1)
facing as shown until it clicks into place.
●● Make sure the memory card is facing the
right way when you insert it. Inserting
memory cards facing the wrong way may
damage the camera.
4 Close the cover.
●● Lower the cover in the direction of the
arrow and press it until it clicks into the
closed position.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● For guidelines on how many shots or hours of recording can be
saved on one memory card, see “Number of Shots per Memory
Card” (= 197).
19
Using the Screen
(2)
(1)
Before Use
Setting the Date and Time
●● Open the screen (1) and rotate it toward
the lens 180° (2).
●● Close the screen in this orientation (3).
(3)
Set the current date and time correctly as follows if the [Date/Time] screen
is displayed when you turn the camera on. Information you specify this
way is recorded in image properties when you shoot, and it is used when
you manage images by shooting date or print images showing the date.
You can also add a date stamp to shots, if you wish (= 45).
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
1 Turn the camera on.
●● The screen can only open to approximately 175° in direction (1).
Be careful not to open the screen any further than this, as it will
damage the camera.
Adjusting the Screen Angle and Orientation
●● You can adjust the angle and orientation
of the screen as needed, to suit shooting
conditions.
●● To protect the screen when the camera
is not in use, always keep it closed and
facing the camera body.
●● Open the screen to activate it when the camera is on. This will
deactivate the viewfinder. Similarly, close the screen (facing the
camera body) to deactivate it and activate the viewfinder.
●● When including yourself in shots, you can view a mirror image
of yourself by rotating the screen around toward the front of the
] button,
camera. To cancel reverse display, press the [
choose [Reverse Disp.] on the [ ] tab, and press the [ ][ ]
buttons to choose [Off].
●● Press the power button.
●● The [Date/Time] screen is displayed.
2 Set the date and time.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose an
option.
●● Press the [ ][
date and time.
] buttons to specify the
●● When finished, press the [
] button.
3 Specify your home time zone.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose your
home time zone.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
4 Finish the setup process.
●● Press the [ ] button when finished.
After a confirmation message, the setting
screen is no longer displayed.
●● To turn off the camera, press the power
button.
20
●● Unless you set the date, time, and home time zone, the [Date/
Time] screen will be displayed each time you turn the camera on.
Specify the correct information.
●● To set daylight saving time (1 hour ahead), choose [ ] in step 2
and then choose [ ] by pressing the [ ][ ] buttons.
Changing the Date and Time
●● Date/time settings can be retained for about 3 weeks by the
camera’s built-in date/time battery (backup battery) after the
battery pack is removed.
●● The date/time battery will be charged in about 4 hours once you
insert a charged battery pack or connect the camera to an AC
adapter kit (sold separately, = 155), even if the camera is left
off.
●● Once the date/time battery is depleted, the [Date/Time] screen will
be displayed when you turn the camera on. Set the correct date
and time as described in “Setting the Date and Time” (= 20).
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Adjust the date and time as follows.
Display Language
1 Access the menu screen.
●● Press the [
] button.
Change the display language as needed.
1 Enter Playback mode.
2 Choose [Date/Time].
●● Move the zoom lever to choose the [
tab.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose
[Date/Time], and then press the [ ]
button.
3 Change the date and time.
●● Follow step 2 in “Setting the Date and
Time” (= 20) to adjust the settings.
●● Press the [
menu screen.
●● Press the [
] button.
]
2 Access the setting screen.
●● Press and hold the [ ] button, and then
immediately press the [
] button.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
] button to close the
21
3 Set the display language.
●● Press the [ ][ ][ ][ ] buttons to choose
a language, and then press the [ ]
button.
●● Once the display language has been set,
the setting screen is no longer displayed.
Before Use
Trying the Camera Out
 Still Images  Movies
Follow these instructions to turn the camera on, shoot still images or
movies, and then view them.
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Shooting (Smart Auto)
For fully automatic selection of the optimal settings for specific scenes,
simply let the camera determine the subject and shooting conditions.
●● The current time is displayed if you wait too long in step 2 after
] button.
pressing the [ ] button before you press the [
In this case, press the [ ] button to dismiss the time display and
repeat step 2.
●● You can also change the display language by pressing the
] button and choosing [Language
] on the [ ] tab.
[
1 Turn the camera on.
●● Press the power button.
●● The startup screen is displayed.
2 Enter [
] mode.
●● Set the mode dial to [
].
●● Aim the camera at the subject. The
camera will make a slight clicking noise
as it determines the scene.
●● Icons representing the scene and image
stabilization mode are displayed in the
upper left of the screen.
●● Frames displayed around any detected
subjects indicate that they are in focus.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
3 Compose the shot.
●● To zoom in and enlarge the subject, move
the zoom lever toward [ ] (telephoto),
and to zoom away from the subject, move
it toward [ ] (wide angle).
22
4
Shoot.
Shooting Still Images
Shooting Movies
1) Start shooting.
1)Focus.
●● Press the shutter button lightly, halfway
down. The camera beeps twice after
focusing, and AF frames are displayed to
indicate image areas in focus.
●● If [Raise the flash] is displayed, lift the
flash with your finger to prepare it for use.
If you prefer not to use the flash, push it
down with your finger, into the camera.
(1)
●● Press the movie button. The camera
beeps once as recording begins, and
[ Rec] is displayed with the elapsed
time (1).
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● Black bars are displayed on the top and
bottom edges of the screen, and the
subject is slightly enlarged. The black
bars indicate image areas not recorded.
●● Frames displayed around any detected
faces indicate that they are in focus.
●● Once recording begins, take your finger
off the movie button.
2) Finish shooting.
●● Press the movie button again to stop
shooting. The camera beeps twice as
recording stops.
2)Shoot.
●● Press the shutter button all the way
down.
●● As the camera shoots, a shutter sound
is played, and in low-light conditions
when you have raised the flash, it fires
automatically.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● Keep the camera still until the shutter
sound ends.
●● After displaying your shot, the camera will
revert to the shooting screen.
23
3 Play movies.
Viewing
●● Press the [ ] button to access the movie
control panel, press the [ ][ ] buttons
to choose [ ], and then press the [ ]
button again.
After shooting images or movies, you can view them on the screen as
follows.
1
Enter Playback mode.
●● Press the [
] button.
(1)
●● Your last shot is displayed.
2 Browse through your images.
●● To view the previous image, press the [ ]
button. To view the next image, press the
[ ] button.
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
●● Playback now begins, and after the movie
] is displayed.
is finished, [
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● To adjust the volume (1), press the
[ ][ ] buttons.
●● To switch to Shooting mode from Playback mode, press the
shutter button halfway.
Erasing Images
You can choose and erase unneeded images one by one. Be careful
when erasing images, because they cannot be recovered.
1 Choose an image to erase.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose an
image.
●● To access this screen (Scroll Display
mode), press and hold the [ ][ ] buttons
for at least one second. In this mode,
press the [ ][ ] buttons to browse
through images.
●● To return to single-image display, press
the [ ] button.
●● Movies are identified by a [
To play movies, go to step 3.
] icon.
2 Erase the image.
●● Press the [ ] button.
●● After [Erase?] is displayed, press the
[ ][ ] buttons to choose [Erase], and
then press the [ ] button.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● The current image is now erased.
●● To cancel erasure, press the [ ][ ]
buttons to choose [Cancel], and then
press the [ ] button.
●● You can choose multiple images to erase at once (= 113).
24
Advanced Guide
1
Camera Basics
Other basic operations and more ways to enjoy your camera, including
shooting and playback options
Before Use
On/Off
Basic Guide
Shooting Mode
Advanced Guide
●● Press the power button to turn the
camera on and prepare for shooting.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● To turn the camera off, press the power
button again.
Playback Mode
●● Press the [
] button to turn the camera
on and view your shots.
●● To turn the camera off, press the [
button again.
]
●● To switch to Playback mode from Shooting mode, press the [
]
button.
●● To switch to Shooting mode from Playback mode, press the
shutter button halfway (= 26).
●● The lens will be retracted after about one minute once the camera
is in Playback mode. You can turn the camera off when the lens is
] button.
retracted by pressing the [
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
25
Power-Saving Features (Auto Power Down)
As a way to conserve battery power, the camera automatically deactivates
the screen (Display Off) and then turns itself off after a specific period of
inactivity.
Power Saving in Shooting Mode
The screen is automatically deactivated after about one minute of
inactivity. In about two more minutes, the lens is retracted and the camera
turns itself off. To activate the screen and prepare for shooting when
the screen is off but the lens is still out, press the shutter button halfway
(= 26).
Before Use
Shutter Button
Basic Guide
To ensure your shots are in focus, always begin by holding the shutter
button halfway down, and once the subject is in focus, press the button all
the way down to shoot.
In this manual, shutter button operations are described as pressing the
button halfway or all the way down.
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
1 Press halfway. (Press lightly to focus.)
●● Press the shutter button halfway. The
camera beeps twice, and AF frames are
displayed around image areas in focus.
Power Saving in Playback Mode
The camera turns itself off automatically after about five minutes of
inactivity.
●● You can deactivate Auto Power Down and adjust the timing of
Display Off, if you prefer (= 147).
●● Power saving is not active while the camera is connected to other
devices via Wi-Fi (= 122), or when connected to a computer
(= 165).
2 Press all the way down. (From the
halfway position, press fully to
shoot.)
●● The camera shoots, as a shutter sound
is played.
●● Keep the camera still until the shutter
sound ends.
●● Images may be out of focus if you shoot without initially pressing
the shutter button halfway.
●● Length of shutter sound playback varies depending on the time
required for the shot. It may take longer in some shooting scenes,
and images will be blurry if you move the camera (or the subject
moves) before the shutter sound ends.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
26
Viewfinder
Before Use
Shooting Modes
Adjust the viewfinder display for sharper images by adjusting the diopter,
as follows.
(5)
1 Activate the viewfinder.
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
(1)
●● Press the [ ] button several times until
the viewfinder goes on (= 28).
(2)
(3)
2 Adjust the diopter.
●● As you look through the viewfinder, turn
the dial one way or the other so that
images look sharp.
Basic Guide
Use the mode dial to access each shooting mode.
(6)
(7)
(4)
(1)
Auto Mode / Hybrid Auto Mode
Fully automatic shooting, with
camera-determined settings
(= 22, = 33, = 35).
(5)
P, Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Modes
Take a variety of shots using
your preferred settings (= 71,
= 92).
(2)
Creative Shot Mode
See several effects applied to
each shot automatically (= 57).
(6)
(3)
Sports Mode
Shoot continuously as the camera
focuses on moving subjects
(= 58).
Movie Mode
For shooting movies (= 67).
You can also shoot movies when
the mode dial is not set to Movie
mode, simply by pressing the
movie button.
(4)
Scene Mode
Shoot with optimal settings for
specific scenes (= 59).
(7)
Creative Filters Mode
Add a variety of effects to images
when shooting (= 60).
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
27
Shooting Display Options
Press the [ ] button to view other information on the screen, or to hide
the information. For details on the information displayed, see “On-Screen
Information” (= 180).
Open the screen to activate it when the camera is on. This will deactivate
the viewfinder. Similarly, close the screen (facing the camera body) to
deactivate it and activate the viewfinder (= 20).
●● Screen brightness is automatically increased by the night view
function when you are shooting under low light, making it easier
to check how shots are composed. However, on-screen image
brightness may not match the brightness of your shots. Note that
any on-screen image distortion or jerky subject motion will not
affect recorded images.
●● For playback display options, see “Switching Display Modes”
(= 102).
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
LCD Monitor (Screen)
No information is displayed
Information is displayed
Viewfinder
No information is displayed
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
Information is displayed
28
Using the FUNC. Menu
Configure commonly used shooting functions through the FUNC. menu as
follows.
Note that menu items and options vary depending on the shooting mode
(= 184).
1
Access the FUNC. menu.
●● Press the [
4 Finish the setup process.
●● Press the [
] button.
●● The screen before you pressed the
[ ] button in step 1 is displayed again,
showing the option you configured.
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● To undo any accidental setting changes, you can restore the
camera’s default settings (= 152).
] button.
2 Choose a menu item.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose a
menu item (1).
●● Available options (2) are shown at the
bottom of the screen.
(1)
(2)
3 Choose an option.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose an
option.
] icon can be
●● Options labeled with a [
configured by pressing the [ ] button.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● To return to the menu items, press the
[ ] button.
29
3 Choose a menu item.
Using the Menu Screen
Configure a variety of camera functions through the menu screen as
follows. Menu items are grouped by purpose on tabs, such as shooting
[ ], playback [
], and so on. Note that available menu items vary
depending on the selected shooting or playback mode (= 187 –
= 194).
1 Access the menu screen.
●● Press the [
●● Press the [ ][
menu item.
] buttons to choose a
●● For menu items with options not shown,
first press the [ ] or [ ] button to switch
screens, and then press the [ ][ ]
buttons to select the menu item.
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● To return to the previous screen, press
] button.
the [
] button.
2 Choose a tab.
●● Move the zoom lever to choose a tab.
●● After you have pressed the [ ][ ]
buttons to choose a tab initially, you can
switch between tabs by pressing the
[ ][ ] buttons.
4 Choose an option.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose an
option.
5 Finish the setup process.
●● Press the [
] button to return to the
screen displayed before you pressed the
[
] button in step 1.
●● To undo any accidental setting changes, you can restore the
camera’s default settings (= 152).
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
30
Deleting Characters
On-Screen Keyboard
Use the on-screen keyboard to enter information for Wi-Fi connections
(= 122). Note that the length and type of information you can enter
varies depending on the function you are using.
(1)
Entering Characters
●● Press the [ ][ ][ ][ ] buttons to choose
a character, and then press the [ ]
button to enter it.
●● The amount of information you can enter
(1) varies depending on the function you
are using.
] or [
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
Confirming Input and Returning to the
Previous Screen
●● Press the [
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
] button.
●● The on-screen keyboard is not available while the viewfinder
(= 28) is in use.
●● You can confirm input and return to the previous screen while the
on-screen keyboard is displayed by closing the screen.
Moving the Cursor
●● Choose [
button.
●● To delete the previous character,
choose [
] and press the [ ] button.
Alternatively, press the [ ] button.
Before Use
] and press the [
]
Entering Line Breaks
●● Choose [
] and press the [
] button.
Switching Input Modes
●● To switch to numbers or symbols, choose
[ ] and press the [ ] button.
●● To switch between uppercase and
lowercase letters, choose [ ] and press
the [ ] button.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● Available input modes vary depending on
the function you are using.
31
Indicator Display
The indicator on the back of the camera (= 3) lights up or blinks
depending on the camera status.
Color
Green
Indicator
Status
Camera Status
On
Camera on
Blinking
Recording/reading/transmitting images, distance
warning (= 174), or cannot focus (when the
flash is deactivated) (= 174)
Before Use
Clock
Basic Guide
You can check the current time.
●● Press and hold the [
] button.
Advanced Guide
●● The current time appears.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● If you hold the camera vertically while
using the clock function, it will switch to
vertical display. Press the [ ][ ] buttons
to change the display color.
●● Press the [ ] button again to cancel the
clock display.
●● When the indicator blinks green, never turn the camera off, open
the memory card/battery cover, or shake or jolt the camera, which
may corrupt images or damage the camera or memory card.
●● When the camera is off, press and hold the [
press the power button to display the clock.
] button, then
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
32
2
Auto Mode / Hybrid Auto Mode
Shooting with Camera-Determined
Settings
For fully automatic selection of the optimal settings for specific scenes,
simply let the camera determine the subject and shooting conditions.
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Shooting (Smart Auto)
 Still Images Convenient mode for easy shots with greater control over shooting
 Movies
1 Turn the camera on.
●● Press the power button.
●● The startup screen is displayed.
2 Enter [
] mode.
●● Set the mode dial to [
].
●● Aim the camera at the subject. The
camera will make a slight clicking noise
as it determines the scene.
●● Icons representing the scene and image
stabilization mode are displayed in
the upper left of the screen (= 37,
= 39).
●● Frames displayed around any detected
subjects indicate that they are in focus.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
33
3 Compose the shot.
(1)
(2)
2)Shoot.
●● To zoom in and enlarge the subject, move
the zoom lever toward [ ] (telephoto),
and to zoom away from the subject,
move it toward [ ] (wide angle). (A
zoom bar (1) showing the zoom position
is displayed, along with the area in focus
(2).)
●● To zoom in or out quickly, move the zoom
lever all the way toward [ ] (telephoto)
or [ ] (wide angle), and to zoom in
or out slowly, move it just a little in the
desired direction.
Basic Guide
●● As the camera shoots, a shutter sound
is played, and in low-light conditions
when you have raised the flash, it fires
automatically.
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● After displaying your shot, the camera will
revert to the shooting screen.
Shooting Movies
1) Start shooting.
Shooting Still Images
1)Focus.
●● Several AF frames are displayed when
multiple areas are in focus.
●● Press the shutter button all the way
down.
●● Keep the camera still until the shutter
sound ends.
4 Shoot.
●● Press the shutter button halfway. The
camera beeps twice after focusing, and
AF frames are displayed to indicate
image areas in focus.
Before Use
(1)
●● Press the movie button. The camera
beeps once as recording begins, and
[ Rec] is displayed with the elapsed
time (1).
●● Black bars are displayed on the top and
bottom edges of the screen, and the
subject is slightly enlarged. The black
bars indicate image areas not recorded.
●● Frames displayed around any detected
faces indicate that they are in focus.
●● Once recording begins, take your finger
off the movie button.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● If [Raise the flash] is displayed, lift the
flash with your finger to prepare it for use.
If you prefer not to use the flash, push it
down with your finger, into the camera.
34
2)Resize the subject and recompose
the shot as needed.
●● To resize the subject, repeat the
operations in step 3.
However, note that the sound of camera
operations will be recorded. Note that
movies shot at zoom factors shown in
blue will look grainy.
●● When you recompose shots, the
focus, brightness, and colors will be
automatically adjusted.
3) Finish shooting.
●● Press the movie button again to stop
shooting. The camera beeps twice as
recording stops.
●● Recording will stop automatically when
the memory card becomes full.
●● The flash firing during shots indicates that the camera has
automatically attempted to ensure optimal colors in the main
subject and background (Multi-area White Balance).
Before Use
Shooting in Hybrid Auto Mode
 Still Images  Movies
You can make a short movie of the day just by shooting still images. The
camera records 2 – 4-second clips of scenes before each shot, which are
later combined in a digest movie.
1
Enter [
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
] mode.
●● Follow step 2 in “Shooting (Smart Auto)”
(= 33) and choose [ ].
2 Compose the shot.
●● Follow steps 3 – 4 in “Shooting (Smart
Auto)” (= 33) to compose the shot and
focus.
●● For more impressive digest movies,
aim the camera at subjects about four
seconds before shooting still images.
3 Shoot.
●● Follow step 4 in “Shooting (Smart Auto)”
(= 33) to shoot a still image.
●● The camera records both a still image
and movie clip. The clip, which ends with
the still image and a shutter sound, forms
a single chapter in the digest movie.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● Battery life is shorter in this mode than in [
] mode, because
digest movies are recorded for each shot.
●● A digest movie may not be recorded if you shoot a still image
] mode, or
immediately after turning the camera on, choosing [
operating the camera in other ways.
●● Camera operating sounds will be recorded in digest movies.
35
●● Digest movie quality is [
] and cannot be changed.
●● Sounds are not played when you press the shutter button halfway
or trigger the self-timer (= 145).
●● Digest movies are saved as separate movie files in the following
] mode.
cases even if they were recorded on the same day in [
-- The digest movie file size reaches approximately 4 GB, or the
total recording time reaches approximately 13 minutes and 20
seconds.
-- The digest movie is protected (= 110).
-- Daylight saving time (= 20) or time zone (= 146) settings
are changed.
-- A new folder is created (= 150).
●● Recorded shutter sounds cannot be modified or erased.
●● If you prefer to record digest movies without still images, adjust
the setting in advance. Choose MENU (= 30) ► [ ] tab ►
[Digest Type] ► [No Stills].
●● Individual chapters can be edited (= 121).
Digest Movie Playback
Display a still image shot in [ ] mode to play a digest movie, or specify
the date of the digest movie to play (= 104).
Still Images
●● A blinking [ ] icon warns that images are more likely to be
blurred by camera shake. In this case, mount the camera on a
tripod or take other measures to keep it still.
●● If your shots are dark despite the flash firing, move closer to
the subject. For details on the flash range, see “Flash Range”
(= 198).
●● The subject may be too close if the camera only beeps once
when you press the shutter button halfway. For details on the
focusing range (shooting range), see “Shooting Range” (= 198).
●● To reduce red-eye and to assist in focusing, the lamp may be
activated when shooting in low-light conditions.
●● A blinking [ ] icon displayed when you attempt to shoot
indicates that shooting is not possible until the flash has finished
recharging. Shooting can resume as soon as the flash is ready,
so either press the shutter button all the way down and wait, or
release it and press it again.
●● The shutter sound will not be played when the Sleeping and
Babies (Sleeping) icons (= 37) are displayed.
●● Although you can shoot again before the shooting screen
is displayed, your previous shot may determine the focus,
brightness, and colors used.
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Still Images/Movies
●● To activate the screen when the camera is on but the screen is
blank (when display is set to the viewfinder), press the [ ] button
several times.
●● If the camera is turned on while the [ ] button is held down, the
camera will no longer sound. To activate sounds again, press the
] button and choose [Mute] on the [ ] tab, and then
[
press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose [Off].
●● You can change how long images are displayed after shots
(= 56).
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
36
Movies
Before Use
Scene Icons
●● The camera may become warm when shooting movies repeatedly
over an extended period. This does not indicate damage.
●● Before shooting a movie, lower the flash with your finger. Be
careful not to touch the microphone (1) when shooting a movie.
Leaving the flash raised, or blocking the microphone may prevent
audio from being recorded or may cause the recording to sound
muffled.
 Still Images  Movies
In [ ] and [
] modes, shooting scenes determined by the camera
are indicated by the icon displayed, and corresponding settings are
automatically selected for optimal focusing, subject brightness, and color.
Depending on the scene, continuous images may be shot (= 38).
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Background
(1)
Subject
Normal Backlit Dark*1 Sunsets Spotlights
People
●● Avoid touching camera controls other than the movie button when
shooting movies, because sounds made by the camera will be
recorded.
●● Once movie recording begins, the image display area changes
and subjects are enlarged to allow for correction of significant
camera shake. To shoot subjects at the same size shown before
shooting, adjust the image stabilization setting (= 90).
●● Audio is recorded in stereo.
●● If you prefer not to record sound, choose MENU (= 30) ►
[ ] tab ► [Sound rec.] ► [Disable].
*2
*3
3
3
–
–
–
–
–
–
Moving People
*
Shadows on Face
*2
Smiling
*3
*3
–
–
–
Sleeping
*2
*3
–
–
–
Babies
*3
*3
–
–
–
Smiling Babies
*3
*3
–
–
–
Sleeping Babies
*2
*3
–
–
–
Moving Children
*3
*3
–
–
–
2
*
3
Other Moving Subjects
*
3
*3
–
–
–
Other Close-Range
Subjects
*2
*3
–
–
Other Subjects
*
*
–
–
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
*1 Tripod Used
*2 The background color of icons is light blue when the background is a blue sky,
dark blue when the background is dark, and gray for all other backgrounds.
*3 The background color of icons is light blue when the background is a blue sky,
and gray for all other backgrounds.
37
●● The background color of [ ], [ ], [ ], [ ], and [
and the background color of [ ] is orange.
] is dark blue,
●● For movies, only People, Other Subjects, and Other Close-Range
Subjects icons are displayed.
●● In [ ] mode, icons are only displayed for People, Shadows on Face,
Other Subjects, and Other Close-Range Subjects.
●● For self-timer shots, icons are not displayed for the following subjects:
moving, smiling, or sleeping people; smiling or sleeping babies;
moving children; and other moving subjects.
●● Icons are not displayed for smiling or sleeping subjects and moving
children in drive mode other than [ ] (= 38, = 46) and when
[Hg Lamp Corr.] is set to [On] and scenes are automatically corrected
(= 53).
●● Backlit icons are not displayed for moving children and smiling people
when the flash is set to [ ].
●● Icons for babies (including smiling and sleeping babies) and moving
children are displayed when [Face ID] is set to [On] and faces of
registered babies (less than two years old) or children (2 – 12 years
old) are detected (= 47). Confirm beforehand that the date and time
are correct (= 20).
●● Try shooting in [ ] mode (= 71) if the scene icon does not
match actual shooting conditions, or if it is not possible to shoot
with your expected effect, color, or brightness.
Continuous Shooting Scenes
Before Use
If you shoot a still image when the following scene icons are displayed,
the camera will shoot continuously. If you press the shutter button halfway
when one of the icons in the table below is displayed, one of the following
icons will be displayed to inform you that the camera will shoot continuous
images: [ ], [ ], or [ ].
Smiling
(including Babies)
Sleeping
(including Babies)
Children
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Consecutive images are captured, and the camera
analyzes details such as facial expressions to save
the image determined to be the best.
Beautiful shots of sleeping faces, created by
combining consecutive shots to reduce camera
shake and image noise.
The AF-assist beam will not light up, the flash will
not fire, and the shutter sound will not be played.
So you don’t miss a photo opportunity of children
who move around, the camera will capture three
consecutive images for each shot.
●● In some scenes, expected images may not be saved, and images
may not look as expected.
●● Focus, image brightness, and color are determined by the first
shot.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● When you want to shoot single images only, press the [
].
and then select [
] button,
38
Image Stabilization Icons
Before Use
On-Screen Frames
 Still Images  Movies
Optimal image stabilization for the shooting conditions is automatically
applied (Intelligent IS). Additionally, the following icons are displayed in
[ ] and [
] modes.
Image stabilization for still images (Normal)
Image stabilization for still images when panning (Panning)*
Image stabilization for macro shots. During movie recording, [
]
is displayed, and image stabilization for macro movie recording is
used (Hybrid IS).
Image stabilization for movies, reducing strong camera shake, as
when shooting while walking (Dynamic)
Image stabilization for slow camera shake, such as when shooting
movies at telephoto (Powered)
No image stabilization, because the camera is mounted on
a tripod or held still by other means. However, during movie
recording, [ ] is displayed, and image stabilization to counteract
wind or other sources of vibration is used (Tripod IS).
 Still Images  Movies
In [
] mode, a variety of frames are displayed once the camera
detects subjects you are aiming the camera at.
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● A white frame is displayed around the subject (or person’s face)
determined by the camera to be the main subject, and gray frames are
displayed around other detected faces. Frames follow moving subjects
within a certain range to keep them in focus. However, if the camera
detects subject movement, only the white frame will remain on the
screen.
●● When you are pressing the shutter button halfway and the camera
detects subject movement, a blue frame is displayed, and the focus
and image brightness are constantly adjusted (Servo AF).
●● Try shooting in [ ] mode (= 71) if no frames are displayed, if
frames are not displayed around desired subjects, or if frames are
displayed on the background or similar areas.
* Displayed when you pan, following moving subjects with the camera. When you
follow subjects moving horizontally, image stabilization only counteracts vertical
camera shake, and horizontal stabilization stops. Similarly, when you follow
subjects moving vertically, image stabilization only counteracts horizontal camera
shake.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● To cancel image stabilization, set [IS Mode] to [Off] (= 90). In
this case, an IS icon is not displayed.
] mode, no [
] icon is displayed.
●● In [
39
Common, Convenient Features
Zooming In Closer on Subjects (Digital Zoom)
 Still Images  Movies
When distant subjects are too far away to enlarge using the optical zoom,
use digital zoom for up to about 260x enlargement.
1 Move the zoom lever toward [
].
●● Moving the zoom lever will display the zoom bar (which indicates
the zoom position). The color of the zoom bar will change
depending on the zoom range.
-- White range: optical zoom range where the image will not
appear grainy.
-- Yellow range: digital zoom range where the image is not
noticeably grainy (ZoomPlus).
-- Blue range: digital zoom range where the image will appear
grainy.
●● Because the blue range will not be available at some resolution
settings (= 52), the maximum zoom factor can be achieved by
following step 1.
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● Hold the lever until zooming stops.
●● Zooming stops at the largest possible
zoom factor (before the image becomes
noticeably grainy), which is then indicated
on the screen.
(1)
2 Move the zoom lever toward [
again.
]
●● The camera zooms in even closer on the
subject.
●● (1) is the current zoom factor.
●● To deactivate digital zoom, choose MENU (= 30) ► [
► [Digital Zoom] ► [Off].
] tab
Easily Reacquiring Subjects after Manual
Zooming (Framing Assist – Seek)
 Still Images  Movies
If you lose track of a subject while zoomed in, you can find it more easily
by temporarily zooming out.
1
Look for the lost subject.
●● Press and hold the [
] button.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● The camera zooms out and displays
a white frame around the area shown
before you pressed the [ ] button.
40
2 Reacquire the subject.
●● Aim the camera so that the subject enters
the white frame, and then release the
[ ] button.
●● The previous magnification is now
restored, so that the area within the white
frame fills the screen again.
●● Some shooting information is not displayed while the camera is
zoomed out.
●● During movie shooting, the white frame is not displayed if you
press the [ ] button. Also note that a changed zoom factor and
camera operating sounds are recorded.
●● If you prefer to shoot at the zoom factor of the screen in step 1,
press the shutter button all the way down.
●● You can adjust the zoom factor that the camera reverts to when
you release the [ ] button by moving the zoom lever to resize
the white frame while you hold the [ ] button.
●● To adjust the area displayed when the [ ] button is pressed,
Display Area], and
access MENU (= 30) ► [ ] tab ► [
choose one of the three options.
●● The zoom factor cannot be changed with the [ ] button after
you press the shutter button all the way down in self-timer mode
(= 44).
Easily Composing Shots after Manual Zooming
(Framing Assist – Lock)
 Still Images  Movies
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
You can reduce camera shake at the telephoto end, which makes it easier
to compose shots.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
1 Compensate camera shake at the
telephoto end.
●● Press and hold the [ ] button. [ ] is
displayed, and image stabilization optimal
for shooting at the telephoto end is
applied.
2 Shoot.
●● While holding the [ ] button, press the
shutter button halfway to focus on the
subject, and then press it all the way
down.
●● The zoom factor cannot be adjusted by pressing the [ ] button
(= 40) while you are holding down the [ ] button.
●● Recomposing the shot while holding down the [ ] button may
make image stabilization less effective. In this case, [ ] is
displayed in gray. If this occurs, release the [ ] button, compose
the shot, and then press it again.
●● If you start recording a movie while holding down the [ ] button,
image stabilization may cause the shot to be recomposed.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
41
3 Shoot.
●● Although no image stabilization icon is shown while you hold
down the [ ] button, image stabilization optimal for shooting at
the telephoto end is applied.
●● To fine-tune the size of subjects gradually, move the zoom lever
while holding down the [ ] button.
Auto Zooming to Keep Faces at a Constant Size
 Still Images ●● Even after you shoot, [ ] remains
around the face displayed at a constant
size.
●● To cancel constant face display size,
press the [ ] button again. [ Auto: Off]
is displayed.
1
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● When
Auto is on, press the [ ][ ]
buttons or turn the [
] dial to choose
the desired option.
 Movies
●● The camera zooms automatically to keep
faces at the specified size.
] Auto mode.
●● Press and release the [
] button quickly.
Face
Keep faces large enough to show facial expressions
clearly.
Upper Body
Keep faces small enough to show the person’s upper
body.
●● [ ] is displayed once a face has been
detected.
Whole Body
Keep faces small enough to show the person’s entire
body.
●● If multiple faces are detected, press the
[ ] button to switch to the face to keep
at a constant size.
Manual
Keep faces at the size specified by moving the zoom
lever. Release the zoom lever once the desired size
has been obtained.
●● [
Basic Guide
Adjusting the Constant Face Display Size
The camera automatically zooms in and out to keep a detected face
(= 83) at a constant size on the screen. If the person moves closer, the
camera automatically zooms out, and vice versa. This size can also be
adjusted, as needed.
Enter [
Before Use
Auto: On] is displayed.
2 Choose the face.
●● The camera zooms in and out to keep the
face framed by [ ] at a constant size on
the screen.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● A face may not be displayed at a constant size relative to the
screen at some zoom factors, or if the person’s head is tilted or
facing the camera indirectly.
●● During movie recording, a changed zoom factor and camera
operating sounds are recorded.
Auto is on, some shooting information is not displayed,
●● When
and some shooting settings cannot be configured.
42
●● If the person whose face is framed with [ ] moves toward the
edge of the screen, the camera zooms out to keep the person in
view.
] button is
●● In step 3, switching [ ] to another face with the [
not possible during movie recording.
●● The zoom factor remains the same after you press the shutter
button all the way down in self-timer mode (= 44), even if the
person’s size relative to the screen changes.
●● The face size can also be adjusted in MENU (= 30) ► [ ]
Auto Settings] ► [
Auto Zoom]. You can choose
tab ► [
[Off] to deactivate this feature and use only the feature described
in “Easily Reacquiring Subjects with Auto Zooming (Seek Assist)”
(= 43).
●● You can zoom in or out with the zoom lever when [Face], [Upper
Body], or [Whole Body] is selected, but the original zoom factor
will be restored in a few seconds after you release the lever.
●● Smile detection can be paused in [ ] mode (= 65) by
pressing the [ ] button. To resume detection, press the button
again.
●● You can clear your specified face size during movie recording by
pressing the [ ] button.
●● Face sizes cannot be changed during movie recording.
Easily Reacquiring Subjects with Auto Zooming
(Seek Assist)
 Still Images  Movies
If you lose track of a subject while zoomed in and move the camera to
look for it, the camera detects this movement and automatically zooms
out, which makes it easier to find the subject.
3 Reacquire the subject.
●● Once you find the subject and stop
moving the camera, the camera zooms
in again.
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
4 Shoot.
●● To cancel this mode, press the [ ]
button again. [ Auto: Off] is displayed.
●● The camera does not zoom out automatically while [ ] is
displayed around a detected face, even if you move the camera.
●● When the feature described in “Auto Zooming to Keep Faces at a
Constant Size” is deactivated, [ ] is displayed around a detected
face, and the camera automatically zooms out when moved.
●● Zooming is not possible while the shutter button is pressed
halfway.
●● To deactivate this feature and use only the feature described in
“Auto Zooming to Keep Faces at a Constant Size” (= 42),
Auto Settings] ►
choose MENU (= 30) ► [ ] tab ► [
[Seek Assist] ► [Off].
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
1 Enter [ ] Auto mode (= 42).
2 Look for the lost subject.
●● When you move the camera to look for
the subject, the camera zooms out to
help you find it.
43
Using the Self-Timer to Avoid Camera Shake
Using the Self-Timer
 Still Images  Still Images  Movies
With the self-timer, you can include yourself in group photos or other
timed shots. The camera will shoot about 10 seconds after you press the
shutter button.
1
This option delays shutter release until about two seconds after you
have pressed the shutter button. If the camera is unsteady while you are
pressing the shutter button, it will not affect your shot.
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
●● Follow step 1 in “Using the Self-Timer”
(= 44) and choose [ ].
Configure the setting.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● Once the setting is complete, [ ] is
displayed.
●● Press the [ ] button, choose [ ] in the
menu, and then choose [ ] (= 29).
●● Once the setting is complete, [
displayed.
Before Use
 Movies
●● Follow step 2 in “Using the Self-Timer”
(= 44) to shoot.
] is
Customizing the Self-Timer
 Still Images  Movies
You can specify the delay (0 – 30 seconds) and number of shots (1 – 10).
1 Choose [
2 Shoot.
●● Following step 1 in “Using the Self-Timer”
(= 44), choose [ ] and press the [ ]
button immediately.
●● For Still Images: Press the shutter button
halfway to focus on the subject, and then
press it all the way down.
2
●● For Movies: Press the movie button.
●● Once you start the self-timer, the lamp
will blink and the camera will play a selftimer sound.
●● Two seconds before the shot, the blinking
and sound will speed up. (The lamp will
remain lit in case the flash fires.)
●● To cancel shooting after you have
triggered the self-timer, press the
[
] button.
●● To restore the original setting, choose [
in step 1.
].
Configure the setting.
●● Turn the [
] dial to choose the [Delay]
time, press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose
the number of [Shots], and then press the
[ ] button.
●● Once the setting is complete, [
displayed.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
] is
●● Follow step 2 in “Using the Self-Timer”
(= 44) to shoot.
]
44
●● For movies shot using the self-timer, [Delay] represents the delay
before recording begins, but the [Shots] setting has no effect.
●● When you specify multiple shots, image brightness and white
balance are determined by the first shot. More time is required
between shots when the flash fires or when you have specified
to take many shots. Shooting will stop automatically when the
memory card becomes full.
●● When a delay longer than two seconds is specified, two seconds
before the shot, the lamp blinking and self-timer sound will speed
up. (The lamp will remain lit in case the flash fires.)
Adding a Date Stamp
 Still Images  Movies
The camera can add the shooting date to images, in the lower-right
corner.
However, note that date stamps cannot be edited or removed, so confirm
beforehand that the date and time are correct (= 20).
2 Shoot.
●● As you take shots, the camera adds the
shooting date or time to the lower-right
corner of images.
●● To restore the original setting, choose
[Off] in step 1.
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● Date stamps cannot be edited or removed.
●● Shots taken without adding a date stamp can be printed with one
as follows.
However, adding a date stamp this way to images that already
have one may cause it to be printed twice.
-- Print using printer functions (= 166)
-- Use camera DPOF print settings (= 170) to print
-- Use the software downloaded from the Canon website
(= 164) to print
1 Configure the setting.
●● Press the [
] button, choose [Date
Stamp ] on the [ ] tab, and then
choose the desired option (= 30).
●● Once the setting is complete, [
displayed.
] is
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
45
Image Display during Playback
Continuous Shooting
 Still Images  Movies
In [
] mode, hold the shutter button all the way down to shoot
continuously.
For details on the continuous shooting speed, see “Continuous Shooting
Speed” (= 198).
1 Configure the setting.
●● Press the [ ] button, and then choose
[ ] (= 29).
●● Once the setting is complete, [
displayed.
] is
2 Shoot.
●● Hold the shutter button all the way down
to shoot continuously.
●● Cannot be used with the self-timer (= 44).
●● Shooting may stop momentarily or continuous shooting may slow
down depending on shooting conditions, camera settings, and the
zoom position.
●● As more shots are taken, shooting may slow down.
●● Shooting may slow down if the flash fires.
●● Multi-area White Balance (= 33) is not available. Similarly, [Hg
Lamp Corr.] (= 53) is set to [Off] and cannot be changed.
Each set of images shot continuously is managed as a single group,
and only the first image in that group will be displayed. To indicate that
the image is part of a group, [
] is displayed in the upper left of the
screen.
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● If you erase a grouped image (= 112), all images in the group
are also erased. Be careful when erasing images.
●● Grouped images can be played back individually (= 107) and
ungrouped (= 107).
●● Protecting (= 110) a grouped image will protect all images in
the group.
●● Grouped images can be viewed individually when played back
using Image Search (= 105) or Smart Shuffle (= 110). In this
case, images are temporarily ungrouped.
●● The following actions are not available for grouped images:
editing Face ID information (= 107), magnifying (= 108),
tagging as favorites (= 115), editing (= 116), printing
(= 166), setting up individual image printing (= 171), or
adding to a photobook (= 172). To do these things, either
view grouped images individually (= 107) or cancel grouping
(= 107) first.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
46
2 Access the setting screen.
Using Face ID
If you register a person ahead of time, the camera will detect that person’s
face, and prioritize focus, brightness, and color for that person when
shooting. In [
] mode, the camera can detect babies and children
based on registered birthdays and optimize settings for them when
shooting.
This function is also useful when searching for a specific registered
person among a large number of images (= 105).
Before Use
●● Press the [
] button, choose [Face
ID Settings] on the [ ] tab, and then
press the [ ] button (= 30).
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose
[Add to Registry], and then press the [
button.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
]
Personal Information
●● Information such as images of a face (face info) registered with
Face ID, and personal information (name, birthday) will be saved
on the camera. Additionally, when registered people are detected,
their names will be recorded in still images. When using the Face ID
function, be careful when sharing the camera or images with others,
and when posting images online where many others can view them.
●● When disposing of a camera or transferring it to another person after
using Face ID, be sure to erase all information (registered faces,
names, and birthdays) from the camera (= 51).
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose [Add
a New Face], and then press the [ ]
button.
3 Register face information.
Registering Face ID Information
●● Aim the camera so that the face of the
person you want to register is inside the
gray frame at the center of the screen.
You can register information (face info, names, birthdays) for up to 12
people to use with Face ID.
●● A white frame on the person’s face
indicates that the face is recognized.
Make sure a white frame is displayed on
the face, and then shoot.
1 Display the screen on the LCD
monitor.
●● Open the LCD monitor to display the
screen (= 20, = 28).
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● If the face is not recognized, you cannot
register face information.
47
6 Continue registering face
●● After [Register?] is displayed, press the
[ ][ ] buttons to choose [OK], and then
press the [ ] button.
information.
●● To register up to 4 more points of face
information (expressions or angles),
repeat step 3.
●● The [Edit Profile] screen is displayed.
birthday.
●● To register a birthday, on the [Edit Profile]
screen, press the [ ][ ] buttons to
choose [Birthday], and then press the [ ]
button.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose an
option.
●● Press the [
date.
][
] buttons to specify the
●● When finished, press the [
] button.
5 Save the settings.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose
[Save], and then press the [ ] button.
●● After a message is displayed, press the
[ ][ ] buttons to choose [Yes], and then
press the [ ] button.
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
●● Registered faces are more easily
recognized if you add a variety of face
information. In addition to a head-on
angle, add a slight side angle, a shot
when smiling, and shots inside and
outside.
4 Register the person’s name and
●● Press the [ ] button to access the
keyboard, and then enter the name
(= 31).
Before Use
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● The flash will not fire when following step 3.
●● If you do not register a birthday in step 4, Babies or Children icons
] mode.
(= 37) will not be displayed in [
●● You can overwrite registered face info, and add face info later if
you have not filled all 5 face info slots (= 47).
Shooting
If you register a person ahead of time, the camera will prioritize that
person as the main subject, and optimize focus, brightness, and color for
that person when shooting.
●● When you point the camera toward a
subject, the names of up to 3 registered
people will be displayed when they are
detected.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● Shoot.
●● Displayed names will be recorded in still
images. Even if people are detected, but
their names are not displayed, the names
(up to 5 people) will be recorded in the
image.
48
●● People other than those registered may be mistakenly detected
as the registered person if they share similar facial features.
Checking and Editing Registered Information
Basic Guide
1 Access the [Check/Edit Info] screen.
●● Registered people may not be correctly detected if the captured
image or scene differs drastically from the registered face
information.
●● If a registered face is not detected, or not easily detected,
overwrite registered information with new face info. Registering
face info right before shooting will allow for easier detection of
registered faces.
●● If a person is mistakenly detected as another person and you
continue shooting, you can edit or erase the name recorded in the
image during playback (= 107).
●● Because faces of babies and children change quickly as they
grow, you should update their face info regularly (= 47).
●● When information display is set to off (= 28), names will not
display, but will be recorded in the image.
●● Names will still be recorded in images even if you clear the
[Shooting Info] check box in [Custom Display] (= 96) on the
[ ] tab so that the names are not displayed.
●● If you don’t want names to be recorded in still images, choose
[Face ID Settings] on the [ ] tab, choose [Face ID], and then
choose [Off].
●● You can check names recorded in images in the playback screen
(simple information display) (= 102).
] mode, names are not displayed on the shooting screen,
●● In [
but they will be recorded in still images.
●● Names recorded in continuous shooting (= 46, = 86) will
continue to be recorded in the same position as for the first shot,
even if subjects move.
Before Use
●● Following step 2 in “Registering Face ID
Information” (= 47), choose [Check/
Edit Info] and press the [ ] button.
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
2 Choose a person to check or edit.
●● Press the [ ][ ][ ][ ] buttons to choose
the person to check or edit, and then
press the [ ] button.
3 Check or edit the information as
needed.
●● To check a name or birthday, choose
[Edit Profile] by pressing the [ ][ ]
buttons, and then press the [ ] button.
On the screen displayed, you can edit
names or birthdays as described in step 4
of “Registering Face ID Information”
(= 47).
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● To check face information, press the
[ ][ ] buttons to choose [Face Info
List], and then press the [ ] button. To
erase face information, press the [ ]
button on the screen displayed, press the
[ ][ ][ ][ ] buttons to choose the face
information to erase, and then press the
[ ] button. After [Erase?] is displayed,
press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose [OK],
and then press the [ ] button.
49
●● Even if you change names in [Edit Profile], the names recorded in
previously shot images will remain the same.
●● You can use the software (= 164) to edit registered names.
Some characters entered with the software may not display on
the camera, but will be correctly recorded in images.
Overwriting and Adding Face Information
You can overwrite existing face information with new face info. You should
update face information regularly, especially with babies and children, as
their faces change quickly as they grow.
You can also add face information when all 5 face info slots have not been
filled.
1 Access the [Add Face Info] screen.
●● Following step 2 in “Registering Face ID
Information” (= 47), choose [Add Face
Info] and press the [ ] button.
2 Choose the name of the person to
overwrite.
●● Press the [ ][ ][ ][ ] buttons to choose
the name of a person whose face info
you want to overwrite, and then press the
[ ] button.
3 Choose the face info to overwrite.
●● Press the [ ][ ][ ][ ] buttons to choose
the face info to overwrite, and then press
the [ ] button.
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
4
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Register face information.
●● Follow step 3 in “Registering Face ID
Information” (= 47) to shoot, and then
register the new face information.
●● Registered faces are more easily
recognized if you add a variety of face
information. In addition to a head-on
angle, add a slight side angle, a shot
when smiling, and shots inside and
outside.
●● You cannot add face information if all 5 information slots are filled.
Follow the steps above to overwrite face information.
●● You can follow the above steps to register new face info when
there is at least one slot open; however, you cannot overwrite
any face information. Instead of overwriting face info, first erase
unwanted existing info (= 49), and then register new face
information (= 47) as needed.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● If five items of face info have already been
registered, a message will be displayed.
Choose [OK] by pressing the [ ][ ]
buttons, and then press the [ ] button.
●● If less than five items of face info are
registered, go to step 4 to add face
information.
50
Erasing Registered Information
You can erase information (face info, names, birthdays) registered to
Face ID. However, names recorded in previously shot images will not be
erased.
1 Access the [Erase Info] screen.
●● Follow step 2 in “Registering Face ID
Information” (= 47) and choose [Erase
Info].
Before Use
Image Customization Features
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
Changing the Aspect Ratio
 Still Images 1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
 Movies
Change the image aspect ratio (ratio of width to height) as follows.
●● Press the [ ] button, choose [ ] in the
menu, and choose the desired option
(= 29).
●● Once the setting is complete, the screen
aspect ratio will be updated.
2 Choose the name of the person
whose info you want to erase.
●● To restore the original setting, repeat this
process but choose [ ].
●● Press the [ ][ ][ ][ ] buttons to choose
the name of a person to erase, and then
press the [ ] button.
●● After [Erase?] is displayed, press the
[ ][ ] buttons to choose [OK], and then
press the [ ] button.
●● If you erase a registered person’s info, you will not be able to
display their name (= 104), overwrite their info (= 107), or
search images for them (= 105).
●● You can also erase names in image information (= 108).
Used for display on widescreen HDTVs or similar display devices.
Same aspect ratio as 35mm film, used for printing images at 5 x
7-inch or postcard sizes.
Native aspect ratio of the camera screen, also used for display
on standard-definition televisions or similar display devices, or for
printing images at 3.5 x 5-inch or A-series sizes.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
Square aspect ratio.
Aspect ratio commonly used for portraits.
●● Not available in [
] mode.
51
Changing Image Resolution (Size)
Before Use
Red-Eye Correction
 Still Images  Movies
Choose from 4 levels of image resolution, as follows. For guidelines on
how many shots at each resolution setting can fit on a memory card, see
“Number of Shots per Memory Card” (= 197).
●● Press the [ ] button, choose [ ] in the
menu, and choose the desired option
(= 29).
●● The option you configured is now
displayed.
 Still Images  Movies
Red-eye that occurs in flash photography can be automatically corrected
as follows.
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
1 Access the [Built-in Flash Settings]
screen.
●● Press the [
] button, choose [Flash
Control] on the [ ] tab, and then press
the [ ] button (= 30).
●● To restore the original setting, repeat this
process but choose [ ].
Guidelines for Choosing Resolution Based on Paper
Size (for 4:3 Images)
A2 (16.5 x 23.4 in.)
A3 – A5 (11.7 x 16.5 – 5.8 x 8.3 in.)
3.5 x 5 in., 5 x 7 in., Postcard
For e-mailing and similar purposes
●● Not available in [
] mode.
2
Configure the setting.
●● Choose [Red-Eye Corr.], and then
choose [On] (= 30).
●● Once the setting is complete, [
displayed.
] is
●● To restore the original setting, repeat this
process but choose [Off].
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● Red-eye correction may be applied to image areas other than
eyes (if the camera misinterprets red eye makeup as red pupils,
for example).
●● You can also correct existing images (= 119).
●● You can also access the screen in step 2 when the flash is up by
]
pressing the [ ] button and immediately pressing the [
button.
52
Correcting Greenish Image Areas from Mercury
Lamps
 Still Images  Movies
In [
] mode, subjects or background in shots of evening scenes
illuminated by mercury lamps may appear to have a greenish tinge. This
greenish tinge can be corrected automatically when shooting, using Multiarea White Balance.
 Still Images  Movies
4 image quality settings are available. For guidelines on the maximum
movie length at each level of image quality that will fit on a memory card,
see “Recording Time per Memory Card” (= 198).
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● Press the [ ] button, choose [
] in
the menu, and choose the desired option
(= 29).
●● Press the [
] button, choose [Hg
Lamp Corr.] on the [ ] tab, and then
choose [On] (= 30).
●● Once the setting is complete, [
displayed.
Before Use
Changing Movie Image Quality
●● The option you configured is now
displayed.
●● To restore the original setting, repeat this
].
process but choose [
] is
●● To restore the original setting, repeat this
process but choose [Off].
Image
Quality
●● After you are finished shooting under mercury lamps, you should
set [Hg Lamp Corr.] back to [Off]. Otherwise, green hues not
caused by mercury lamps may be corrected by mistake.
●● Try taking some test shots first to make sure you obtain the
desired results.
●● In continuous shooting (= 46), this setting is set to [Off] and
cannot be changed.
Resolution
Frame Rate
Details
For shooting in Full
] enables
HD. [
movies with smoother
motion
1920 x 1080
60 fps
1920 x 1080
30 fps
1280 x 720
30 fps
For shooting in HD
640 x 480
30 fps
For shooting in
standard definition
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● In [
], [
], and [
] modes, black bars displayed on
the top and bottom edges of the screen indicate image areas not
recorded.
53
Before Use
Magnifying the Area in Focus
Helpful Shooting Features
 Still Images Using the Electronic Level
 Movies
You can check the focus by pressing the shutter button halfway, which will
enlarge the portion of the image in focus in the AF frame.
 Still Images  Movies
An electronic level can be displayed on the screen when shooting as a
guideline to determine if the camera is level.
1 Display the electronic level.
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
1 Configure the setting.
●● Press the [
] button, choose [AFPoint Zoom] on the [ ] tab, and then
choose [On] (= 30).
●● Press the [ ] button several times to
display the electronic level.
2 Check the focus.
2 Level the camera as needed.
●● Level the camera so that the center of the
electronic level is green.
●● If the electronic level is not displayed in step 1, press the
] button, and on the [ ] tab, choose [Custom Display].
[
Add a [ ] to [ ] or [ ] to choose the electronic level.
●● Tilting the camera too far forward or backward will prevent you
from using the electronic level, which will turn gray.
●● The electronic level is not displayed during movie recording.
●● If you hold the camera vertically, the orientation of the electronic
level will be updated automatically to match the camera orientation.
●● If your shots are not level even if you use the electronic level, try
calibrating the electronic level (= 150).
●● Press the shutter button halfway. The
face detected as the main subject is now
magnified.
●● To restore the original setting, choose
[Off] in step 1.
●● The area in focus is not magnified in the following cases when the
shutter button is pressed halfway.
-- If a face was not detected, if the person is too close to the
camera and their face is too large for the screen, or if the
camera detects subject movement
-- When digital zoom is used (= 40)
-- When Tracking AF is used (= 83)
-- When a TV is used as a display (= 157)
] mode.
●● Not available in [
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
54
Checking for Closed Eyes
Before Use
Customizing Camera Operation
 Still Images  Movies
[ ] is displayed when the camera detects that people may have closed
their eyes.
1 Configure the setting.
●● Press the [
] button, choose [Blink
Detection] on the [ ] tab, and then
choose [On] (= 30).
Basic Guide
Customize shooting functions on the [ ] tab of the menu screen as follows.
For instructions on menu functions, see “Using the Menu Screen” (= 30).
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Deactivating the AF-Assist Beam
 Still Images  Movies
You can deactivate the lamp that normally lights up to help you focus
when you press the shutter button halfway in low-light conditions.
●● Press the [
] button, choose [AFassist Beam] on the [ ] tab, and then
choose [Off] (= 30).
●● To restore the original setting, repeat this
process but choose [On].
2 Shoot.
●● [ ] flashes when the camera detects a
person whose eyes are closed.
Deactivating the Red-Eye Reduction Lamp
●● To restore the original setting, choose
[Off] in step 1.
●● When you have specified multiple shots in [ ] mode, this
function is only available for the final shot.
●● A frame is displayed around people whose eyes are closed when
you have selected [2 sec.], [4 sec.], [8 sec.], or [Hold] in [Display
Time] (= 56).
●● This feature is not available during continuous shooting in [ ]
mode (= 38).
●● This feature is not available in continuous shooting mode
(= 46, = 86).
 Still Images  Movies
You can deactivate the red-eye reduction lamp that lights up to reduce
red-eye when the flash is used in low-light shots.
1 Access the [Built-in Flash Settings]
screen.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● Press the [
] button, choose [Flash
Control] on the [ ] tab, and then press
the [ ] button (= 30).
2 Configure the setting.
●● Choose [Red-Eye Lamp], and then
choose [Off] (= 30).
●● To restore the original setting, repeat this
process but choose [On].
55
Changing the Screen Displayed after Shots
Changing the Image Display Style after Shots
 Still Images Change the way images are displayed after shots as follows.
 Movies
1 Set [Display Time] to [2 sec.],
[4 sec.], [8 sec.], or [Hold] (= 56).
You can change how long images are displayed and what information is
displayed immediately after shooting.
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose
[Display Info]. Press the [ ][ ] buttons to
choose the desired option.
1 Access the [Review image after
shooting] screen.
2
Basic Guide
2 Configure the setting.
Changing the Image Display Period after Shots
●● Press the [
] button, choose
[Review image after shooting] on the
[ ] tab, and then press the [ ] button
(= 30).
Before Use
●● To restore the original setting, repeat this
process but choose [Off].
Off
Displays only the image.
Detailed
Displays shooting details (= 181).
Configure the setting.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose
[Display Time]. Press the [ ][ ] buttons
to choose the desired option.
●● To restore the original setting, repeat this
process but choose [Quick].
Quick
Displays images only until you can shoot again.
2 sec., 4 sec.,
8 sec.
Displays images for the specified time. Even while
the shot is displayed, you can take another shot by
pressing the shutter button halfway again.
Hold
Displays images until you press the shutter button
halfway.
Off
No image display after shots.
●● By pressing the [ ] button while an image is displayed after
shooting, you can switch the display information. Note that the
settings of [Display Info] are not changed. You can also erase
images, by pressing the [ ] button.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
56
3
Other Shooting Modes
Shoot more effectively in various scenes, and take shots enhanced with
unique image effects or captured using special functions
Enjoying a Variety of Images from
Each Shot (Creative Shot)
 Still Images  Movies
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
The camera determines the subject and shooting conditions, automatically
applying special effects and recomposing the shot to emphasize the
subject. Six still images are recorded for each shot. You can capture
multiple still images with effects using camera-determined settings.
1 Enter [
] mode.
●● Set the mode dial to [
].
2 Shoot.
●● Press the shutter button all the way
down. As you shoot, the shutter sound is
played three times.
●● After the six images are displayed
in succession, they are displayed
simultaneously for about two seconds.
●● To keep the images displayed until you
press the shutter button halfway, press
the [ ] button. For full-screen display in
this state, choose an image by pressing
the [ ][ ][ ][ ] buttons, and then press
the [ ] button.
●● To return to the original display, press the
] button.
[
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● Shooting will take some time when the flash fires, but hold the
camera steady until the shutter sound is played three times.
●● The six images are managed together as a group (= 107).
●● Simultaneous display of the six images as shown in step 2 is only
available immediately after you shoot.
57
Choosing Effects
Before Use
Moving Subjects (Sports)
 Still Images You can choose effects for images captured in [
 Movies
] mode.
●● After choosing [
] mode, turn the [
dial to choose the effect.
 Still Images  Movies
Shoot continuously as the camera focuses on moving subjects.
]
1 Enter [
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
] mode.
●● Set the mode dial to [
].
2 Focus.
Auto
All effects
Retro
Images resemble old photos
Monochrome
Images are generated in one color
Special
Bold, distinctive-looking images
Natural
Subdued, natural-looking images
●● While you are pressing the shutter button
halfway, the camera will continue to
adjust focus and image brightness where
the blue frame is displayed.
3 Shoot.
●● Hold the shutter button all the way down
to shoot continuously.
●● In [ ] mode, shots may look grainy because the ISO speed
(= 73) is increased to suit the shooting conditions.
●● For details on the shooting range in [ ] mode, see “Shooting
Range” (= 198).
●● There may be a delay after continuous shooting before you can
shoot again. Note that some types of memory cards may delay
your next shot even longer. SD Speed Class 6 or higher memory
cards are recommended.
●● Shooting may slow down depending on shooting conditions,
camera settings, and the zoom position.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
58
Shooting under Low Light (Low Light)
Specific Scenes
 Still Images ●● Shoot with minimal camera and subject
shake even in low-light conditions.
Choose a mode matching the shooting scene, and the camera will
automatically configure the settings for optimal shots.
1 Enter [
 Movies
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
] mode.
●● Set the mode dial to [
].
Shooting with Snowy Backgrounds
(Snow)
 Still Images 2 Choose a shooting mode.
3 Shoot.
 Movies
●● Bright, natural-colored shots of people
against snowy backgrounds.
●● Press the [ ] button, choose [ ] in the
menu, and then choose a shooting mode
(= 29).
Shooting Fireworks (Fireworks)
 Still Images  Movies
●● Vivid shots of fireworks.
Shooting Portraits (Portrait)
 Still Images 1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
 Movies
●● Take shots of people with a softening
effect.
Shooting Evening Scenes without
Using a Tripod (Handheld NightScene)
 Still Images  Movies
●● Beautiful shots of evening scenes or
portraits with evening scenery in the
background, without the need to hold the
camera very still (as with a tripod).
●● Subjects appear larger in [ ] mode compared to other modes.
●● In [ ] mode, shots may look grainy because the ISO speed
(= 73) is increased to suit the shooting conditions.
●● Because the camera will shoot continuously in [ ] mode, hold it
steady while shooting.
●● In [ ] mode, excessive motion blur or certain shooting conditions
may prevent you from obtaining the desired results.
●● In [ ] mode, mount the camera on a tripod or take other
measures to keep it still and prevent camera shake. Additionally,
you should set [IS Mode] to [Off] when using a tripod or other
means to secure the camera (= 90).
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● A single image is created by combining
consecutive shots, reducing camera
shake and image noise.
59
●● When you use a tripod for evening scenes, shooting in [
]
mode instead of [ ] mode will give better results (= 33).
●● [ ] mode resolution is [ ] (2304 x 1728) and cannot be changed.
●● In [ ] mode, although no frames are displayed when you press
the shutter button halfway, optimal focus is still determined.
Before Use
Image Effects (Creative Filters)
Basic Guide
Add a variety of effects to images when shooting.
1 Enter [
Advanced Guide
] mode.
●● Set the mode dial to [
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
].
2 Choose a shooting mode.
●● Press the [ ] button, choose [ ] in the
menu, and then choose a shooting mode
(= 29).
3 Shoot.
Shooting in Vivid Colors (Super Vivid)
 Still Images  Movies
●● Shots in rich, vivid colors.
Posterized Shots (Poster Effect)
 Still Images Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
 Movies
●● Shots that resemble an old poster or
illustration.
●● In [ ] and [ ] modes, try taking some test shots first, to make
sure you obtain the desired results.
60
Adding Artistic Effects
Shooting High-Contrast Scenes
(High Dynamic Range)
 Still Images 1 Choose [
●● Follow steps 1 – 2 in “Image Effects
(Creative Filters)” (= 60) and choose
[ ].
 Movies
Three consecutive images are captured at different brightness levels
each time you shoot, and the camera combines image areas with optimal
brightness to create a single image. This mode can reduce the washedout highlights and loss of detail in shadows that tend to occur in highcontrast shots.
].
●● Follow steps 1 – 2 in “Image Effects
(Creative Filters)” (= 60) and choose
[ ].
2 Shoot.
Before Use
●● Turn the [
effect.
] dial to choose a color
Natural
Images are natural and organic.
Art Standard
Images resemble paintings, with subdued contrast.
Art Vivid
Images resemble vivid illustrations.
Art Bold
Images resemble oil paintings, with bold edges.
Art Embossed
Images resemble old photos, with bold edges and
dark ambiance.
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● Hold the camera steady as you shoot.
When you press the shutter button all
the way down, the camera will take three
shots and combine them.
●● Excessive motion blur or certain shooting conditions may prevent
you from obtaining the desired results.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● If excessive camera shake interferes with shooting, mount
the camera on a tripod or take other measures to keep it still.
Additionally, you should set [IS Mode] to [Off] when using a tripod
or other means to secure the camera (= 90).
●● Any subject movement will cause images to look blurry.
●● There will be a delay before you can shoot again, as the camera
processes and combines the images.
61
Shooting with a Fish-Eye Lens Effect
(Fish-Eye Effect)
 Still Images  Movies
Shoot with the distorting effect of a fish-eye lens.
1 Choose [
].
●● Follow steps 1 – 2 in “Image Effects
(Creative Filters)” (= 60) and choose
[ ].
2 Choose an effect level.
●● Turn the [
level.
Before Use
Shots Resembling Miniature Models
(Miniature Effect)
] dial to choose an effect
●● A preview is shown of how your shot will
look with the effect applied.
3 Shoot.
●● Try taking some test shots first, to make sure you obtain the
desired results.
 Still Images Basic Guide
 Movies
Advanced Guide
Creates the effect of a miniature model, by blurring image areas above
and below your selected area.
You can also make movies that look like scenes in miniature models by
choosing the playback speed before the movie is recorded. People and
objects in the scene will move quickly during playback. Note that sound is
not recorded.
1
Choose [
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
].
●● Follow steps 1 – 2 in “Image Effects
(Creative Filters)” (= 60) and choose
[ ].
●● A white frame is displayed, indicating the
image area that will not be blurred.
2 Choose the area to keep in focus.
●● Press the [
] button.
●● Move the zoom lever to resize the frame,
and press the [ ][ ] buttons to move it.
3 For movies, choose the movie
playback speed.
●● Turn the [
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
] dial to choose the speed.
4 Return to the shooting screen and
shoot.
●● Press the [ ] button to return to the
shooting screen, and then shoot.
62
Playback Speed and Estimated Playback Time
(for One-Minute Clips)
Speed
Before Use
Shooting with a Toy Camera Effect
(Toy Camera Effect)
Basic Guide
Playback Time
 Still Images Approx. 12 sec.
Approx. 6 sec.
Advanced Guide
This effect makes images resemble shots from a toy camera by vignetting
(darker, blurred image corners) and changing the overall color.
1 Choose [
Approx. 3 sec.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
].
●● Follow steps 1 – 2 in “Image Effects
(Creative Filters)” (= 60) and choose
[
].
●● The zoom is not available when shooting movies. Be sure to set
the zoom before shooting.
●● Try taking some test shots first, to make sure you obtain the
desired results.
2 Choose a color tone.
●● Turn the [
tone.
●● To switch the orientation of the frame to vertical, press the [ ][ ]
buttons in step 2. To move the frame, press the [ ][ ] buttons
again. To return the frame to horizontal orientation, press the
[ ][ ] buttons.
●● Holding the camera vertically will change the orientation of the
frame.
] and [ ] at
●● Movie image quality is [ ] at an aspect ratio of [
] (= 51). These quality settings cannot
an aspect ratio of [
be changed.
●● The zoom factor cannot be changed with the [ ] button on the
screens in steps 2 and 3, or while shooting movies.
 Movies
] dial to choose a color
●● A preview is shown of how your shot will
look with the effect applied.
3
Shoot.
Standard
Shots resemble toy camera images.
Warm
Images have a warmer tone than with [Standard].
Cool
Images have a cooler tone than with [Standard].
●● Try taking some test shots first, to make sure you obtain the
desired results.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
63
Shooting with a Soft Focus Effect
 Still Images  Movies
This function allows you to shoot images as if a soft focus filter were
attached to the camera. You can adjust the effect level as desired.
1 Choose [
 Still Images 1 Choose [
].
Advanced Guide
].
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
2 Choose a color tone.
●● Turn the [
tone.
] dial to choose an effect
] dial to choose a color
●● A preview is shown of how your shot will
look with the effect applied.
●● A preview is shown of how your shot will
look with the effect applied.
●● Try taking some test shots first, to make sure you obtain the
desired results.
Basic Guide
●● Follow steps 1 – 2 in “Image Effects
(Creative Filters)” (= 60) and choose
[ ].
2 Choose an effect level.
3 Shoot.
 Movies
Shoot images in black and white, sepia, or blue and white.
●● Follow steps 1 – 2 in “Image Effects
(Creative Filters)” (= 60) and choose
[ ].
●● Turn the [
level.
Before Use
Shooting in Monochrome
3 Shoot.
B/W
Black and white shots.
Sepia
Sepia tone shots.
Blue
Blue and white shots.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
64
Special Modes for Other Purposes
Auto Shooting after Face Detection (Smart Shutter)
 Still Images  Movies
Auto Shooting after Smile Detection
 Still Images  Movies
The camera shoots automatically after detecting a smile, even without you
pressing the shutter button.
1 Choose [
].
●● Follow steps 1 – 2 in “Specific Scenes”
(= 59) and choose [ ], and then
press the [ ] button.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose [
and then press the [ ] button.
],
●● The camera now enters shooting standby
mode, and [Smile Detection on] is
displayed.
2 Aim the camera at a person.
●● Each time the camera detects a smile, it
will shoot after the lamp lights up.
●● To pause smile detection, press the [ ]
button. Press the [ ] button again to
resume detection.
●● Switch to another mode when you finish shooting, or the camera
will continue shooting each time a smile is detected.
Before Use
●● You can also shoot as usual by pressing the shutter button.
●● The camera can detect smiles more easily when subjects face
the camera and open their mouth wide enough so that teeth are
visible.
●● To change the number of shots, press the [ ][ ] buttons
after choosing [ ] in step 1. [Blink Detection] (= 55) is only
available for the final shot.
●● Automatic shooting is not available while you are holding down
the [ ] button.
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Using the Wink Self-Timer
 Still Images  Movies
Aim the camera at a person and press the shutter button all the way
down. The camera will shoot about two seconds after a wink is detected.
1 Choose [
].
●● Follow steps 1 – 2 in “Specific Scenes”
(= 59) and choose [ ], and then
press the [ ] button.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose [
and then press the [ ] button.
],
2 Compose the shot and press the
shutter button halfway.
●● Make sure a green frame is displayed
around the face of the person who will
wink.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
3 Press the shutter button all the way
down.
●● The camera now enters shooting standby
mode, and [Wink to take picture] is
displayed.
●● The lamp blinks and the self-timer sound
is played.
65
4 Face the camera and wink.
●● The camera will shoot about two seconds
after detecting a wink by the person
whose face is inside the frame.
●● To cancel shooting after you have
triggered the self-timer, press the
] button.
[
●● If the wink is not detected, wink again slowly and deliberately.
●● Winking may not be detected if eyes are obscured by hair, a hat,
or glasses.
●● Closing and opening both eyes at once will also be detected as
a wink.
●● If winking is not detected, the camera will shoot about 15 seconds
later.
●● To change the number of shots, press the [ ][ ] buttons
after choosing [ ] in step 1. [Blink Detection] (= 55) is only
available for the final shot.
●● If no one is in the shooting area when the shutter button is
pressed all the way down, the camera will shoot after a person
enters the shooting area and winks.
●● The zoom factor cannot be changed with the [ ] button after you
press the shutter button all the way down.
Using the Face Self-Timer
Before Use
 Still Images  Movies
The camera will shoot about two seconds after detecting that the face of
another person (such as the photographer) has entered the shooting area
(= 83). This is useful when including yourself in group photos or similar
shots.
1 Choose [
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
].
●● Follow steps 1 – 2 in “Specific Scenes”
(= 59) and choose [ ], and then
press the [ ] button.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose [
and then press the [ ] button.
2
],
Compose the shot and press the
shutter button halfway.
●● Make sure a green frame is displayed
around the face you focus on and white
frames around other faces.
3 Press the shutter button all the way
down.
●● The camera now enters shooting standby
mode, and [Look straight at camera to
start count down] is displayed.
●● The lamp blinks and the self-timer sound
is played.
4 Join the subjects in the shooting
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
area and look at the camera.
●● After the camera detects a new face, the
lamp blinking and self-timer sound will
speed up. (When the flash fires, the lamp
will remain lit.) About two seconds later,
the camera will shoot.
●● To cancel shooting after you have
triggered the self-timer, press the
] button.
[
66
●● Even if your face is not detected after you join the others in the
shooting area, the camera will shoot about 15 seconds later.
●● To change the number of shots, press the [ ][ ] buttons
after choosing [ ] in step 1. [Blink Detection] (= 55) is only
available for the final shot.
●● The zoom factor cannot be changed with the [ ] button after you
press the shutter button all the way down.
Before Use
Shooting Various Movies
 Still Images  Movies
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
Shooting Movies in Movie Mode
 Still Images 1 Enter [
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
 Movies
] mode.
●● Set the mode dial to [
].
●● Black bars are displayed on the top and
bottom edges of the screen, and the
subject is slightly enlarged. The black
bars indicate image areas not recorded.
2 Configure the settings to suit the
movie (= 182).
3
Shoot.
●● Press the movie button.
●● To stop movie recording, press the movie
button again.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
67
Locking or Changing Image Brightness before Shooting
 Still Images  Movies
Before Use
Sound Settings
 Still Images You can lock the exposure before or during recording or adjust it in 1/3-stop
increments within a range of −2 to +2 stops.
Adjusting the Recording Volume
1 Lock the exposure.
●● While holding the shutter button halfway
down, press the [ ] button to lock the
exposure. [ ] is displayed.
●● To unlock the exposure, press the [
button again.
 Movies
]
2 Adjust the exposure.
●● Turn the [
] dial to adjust the
exposure, as you watch the screen.
3 Shoot.
●● To make the sound of the [
] dial quieter while you are
recording a movie, press the [ ][ ] buttons and adjust the setting.
●● You can switch between adjusting the exposure compensation
and focal position during MF (= 79) movie recording each time
you press the [ ] button. Press the [ ][ ] buttons to configure
these settings.
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Although the recording level (volume) is automatically adjusted to reduce
distortion, you can set the level manually to suit the shooting scene.
1 Access the [Sound rec.] screen.
●● Press the [
] button, choose
[Sound rec.] on the [ ] tab, and then
press the [ ] button (= 30).
2 Configure the setting.
●● Choose [Sound rec.], and then choose
[Manual] (= 30).
●● Press the [ ] button, and then press the
[ ][ ] buttons to configure the [Level]
setting.
●● To restore the original setting, repeat this
process but choose [Auto].
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
68
Deactivating the Wind Filter
Reduce audio distortion from strong wind. (To ensure natural sound, do
not use unless there is wind.) In this case, you can deactivate the wind
filter.
●● Access the [Sound rec.] screen as
described in step 1 of “Adjusting the
Recording Volume”.
●● Choose [Wind filter/Attenuator], and then
press the [ ] button.
●● Choose [Wind Filter], and then choose
[Off] (= 30).
Using the Attenuator
The attenuator can reduce audio distortion in noisy environments.
However, in quiet environments, it lowers the sound-recording level.
●● Access the [Sound rec.] screen as
described in step 1 of “Adjusting the
Recording Volume”.
●● Choose [Wind filter/Attenuator], and then
press the [ ] button.
●● Choose [Attenuator], and then choose
[On] (= 30).
Before Use
Shooting iFrame Movies
 Still Images  Movies
Shoot movies that can be edited with iFrame-compatible software or
devices. You can quickly edit, save, and manage your iFrame movies
using the software (= 164).
1
Choose [
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
].
●● Set the mode dial to [
].
●● Press the [ ] button, choose [ ] in the
menu, and then choose [ ] (= 29).
●● Black bars displayed on the top and
bottom edges of the screen indicate
image areas not recorded.
2
Shoot (= 67).
●● Press the movie button.
●● To stop movie recording, press the movie
button again.
●● The resolution is [
] (= 53) and cannot be changed.
●● iFrame is a video format developed by Apple Inc.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
69
Shooting Super Slow Motion Movies
 Still Images  Movies
You can shoot fast-moving subjects for playback later in slow motion. Note
that sound is not recorded.
1 Choose [
].
●● Set the mode dial to [
].
●● Press the [ ] button, choose [ ] in the
menu, and then choose [ ] (= 29).
●● Zooming is not available during recording, even if you move the
zoom lever.
●● Focus, exposure, and color are determined when you press the
movie button.
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● When you play the movie (= 101), it will be played back in slow
motion.
●● You can change the playback speed of movies by using the
software (= 164).
2 Choose a frame rate.
●● Press the [ ] button, choose [
] in
the menu, and choose the desired frame
rate (= 29).
●● The option you configured is now
displayed.
3 Shoot (= 67).
●● Press the movie button.
●● A bar showing the elapsed time is
displayed. Maximum clip length is approx.
30 sec.
●● To stop movie recording, press the movie
button again.
Frame Rate
Image Quality
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
Playback Time
(For a 30-sec. Clip)
240 fps
(320 x 240)
Approx. 4 min.
120 fps
(640 x 480)
Approx. 2 min.
70
4
P Mode
More discerning shots, in your preferred shooting style
Shooting in Program AE ([P] Mode)
 Still Images  Movies
You can customize many function settings to suit your preferred shooting
style.
1 Enter [
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
] mode.
●● Set the mode dial to [ ].
2 Customize the settings as desired
(= 72 – = 90), and then shoot.
●● Instructions in this chapter apply to the camera with the mode dial set
to [ ] mode.
●● [ ]: Program AE; AE: Auto Exposure
●● Before using a function introduced in this chapter in modes other than
[ ], make sure the function is available in that mode (= 182).
●● If adequate exposure cannot be obtained when you press the
shutter button halfway, shutter speeds and aperture values are
displayed in orange. In this case, try adjusting the ISO speed
(= 73) or activating the flash (if subjects are dark, = 86),
which may enable adequate exposure.
●● Movies can be recorded in [ ] mode as well, by pressing the
movie button. However, some FUNC. (= 29) and MENU
(= 30) settings may be automatically adjusted for movie
recording.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
71
2 Compose the shot and shoot.
Image Brightness (Exposure)
Adjusting Image Brightness
(Exposure Compensation)
 Still Images ●● Press the [ ] button. As you watch the
screen, turn the [
] dial to adjust
brightness, and then press the [ ] button
again when finished.
●● The correction level you specified is now
displayed.
] is
●● AE: Auto Exposure
●● After the exposure is locked, you can adjust the combination
] dial
of shutter speed and aperture value by turning the [
(Program Shift).
 Movies
The standard exposure set by the camera can be adjusted in 1/3-stop
increments, in a range of –3 to +3.
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Changing the Metering Method
 Still Images  Movies
Adjust the metering method (how brightness is measured) to suit shooting
conditions as follows.
●● Press the [ ] button, choose [ ] in the
menu, and choose the desired option
(= 2 9).
●● The option you configured is now
displayed.
Locking Image Brightness / Exposure (AE Lock)
 Still Images Before Use
●● After one shot, AE is unlocked and [
no longer displayed.
 Movies
Before shooting, you can lock the exposure, or you can specify focus and
exposure separately.
Evaluative
For typical shooting conditions, including backlit
shots. Automatically adjusts exposure to match the
shooting conditions.
●● Aim the camera at the subject to shoot
with the exposure locked. With the
shutter button pressed halfway, press the
[ ] button.
Center
Weighted
Avg.
Determines the average brightness of light across
the entire image area, calculated by treating
brightness in the central area as more important.
●● [ ] is displayed, and the exposure is
locked.
Spot
Metering restricted to within the [ ] (Spot AE Point
frame). You can also link the Spot AE Point frame to
the AF frame (= 73).
1 Lock the exposure.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● To unlock AE, release the shutter button
and press the [ ] button again. In this
case, [ ] is no longer displayed.
72
Linking the Spot AE Point Frame to the AF Frame
 Still Images 1 Set the metering method to [
 Movies
 Still Images ].
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons or turn the [
dial to choose an ISO speed.
2 Configure the setting.
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
]
●● The option you configured is now
displayed.
●● Press the [
] button, choose [Spot
AE Point] on the [ ] tab, and then
choose [AF Point] (= 30).
●● Not available when [AF Frame] is set to [Face Detect] (= 83)
or [Tracking AF] (= 83).
 Movies
●● Press the [ ] button, and then choose
[ ] in the menu (= 29).
●● Follow the steps in “Changing the
Metering Method” (= 72) to choose
[ ].
●● The Spot AE Point frame will now be
linked to the movement of the AF frame
(= 82).
Before Use
Changing the ISO Speed
AUTO
Automatically adjusts the ISO
speed to suit the shooting mode
and conditions.
100, 125, 160, 200
Low
For shooting outdoors
in fair weather.
250, 320, 400, 500, 640, 800
Slightly
Low
For shooting in
cloudy conditions, or
at twilight.
1000, 1250, 1600, 2000, 2500, 3200
Slightly
High
For shooting night
scenes, or in dark
rooms.
●● If motion blur is not reduced enough at an ISO speed of [3200],
you can specify [ ] mode (= 59) and choose [4000], [5000],
or [6400].
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
73
●● To view the automatically determined ISO speed when you have
set the ISO speed to [AUTO], press the shutter button halfway.
●● Although choosing a lower ISO speed may reduce image
graininess, there may be a greater risk of subject and camera
shake in some shooting conditions.
●● Choosing a higher ISO speed will increase shutter speed, which
may reduce subject and camera shake and increase the flash
range. However, shots may look grainy.
Changing the Noise Reduction Level (High ISO NR)
You can choose from 3 levels of noise reduction: [Standard], [High], [Low].
This function is especially effective when shooting at high ISO speeds.
●● Press the [
] button, choose [High
ISO NR] on the [ ] tab, and then choose
the desired option (= 30).
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Adjusting ISO Auto Settings
 Still Images  Movies
When the camera is set to [AUTO], maximum ISO speed can be specified
in a range of [400] – [3200], and sensitivity can be specified in a range of
three levels.
1 Access the setting screen.
●● Press the [
] button, choose [ISO
Auto Settings] on the [ ] tab, and then
press the [ ] button (= 30).
2 Configure the setting.
●● Choose a menu item to configure, and
then choose the desired option (= 30).
●● Not available with [
] or [
] (= 89).
Auto Exposure Bracketing (AEB Shooting)
 Still Images  Movies
Three consecutive images are captured at different exposure levels
(standard exposure, underexposure, and then overexposure) each
time you shoot. You can adjust the amount of underexposure and
overexposure (relative to standard exposure) from –2 to +2 stops in 1/3stop increments.
1 Choose [
].
●● Press the [ ] button, choose [ ] in the
menu, and then choose [ ] (= 29).
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● You can also access the [ISO Auto Settings] screen when the
ISO speed setting screen (= 73) is displayed, by pressing the
] button.
[
74
2 Configure the setting.
●● Press the [ ] button, and then adjust
the setting by pressing the [ ][ ] buttons
or turning the [
] dial.
Before Use
●● You can also correct existing images (= 118).
Basic Guide
Dynamic Range Correction (DR Correction)
 Still Images  Movies
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Tone down bright image areas, which might otherwise look washed out,
as follows.
●● AEB shooting is only available in [ ] mode (= 86).
●● Continuous shooting (= 86) is not available in this mode.
●● Press the [ ] button, choose [ ] in the
menu, and choose the desired option
(= 29).
●● If exposure compensation is already in use (= 72), the value
specified for that function is treated as the standard exposure
level for this function.
●● You can also access the setting screen of step 2 by pressing
] button when the exposure compensation screen
the [
(= 72) is displayed.
●● Three shots are taken, regardless of any quantity specified in [ ]
(= 44).
●● In [Blink Detection] mode (= 55), this function is only available
for the final shot.
Correcting Image Brightness (i-Contrast)
 Still Images ●● Once the setting is complete, [
displayed.
Options
Available ISO Speed
(= 73)
Details
–
Automatic adjustment to prevent
washed-out highlights
[AUTO], [100] – [3200]
Tone down highlights by about 200%
relative to the brightness level of [ ].
[AUTO], [200] – [3200]
Tone down highlights by about 400%
relative to the brightness level of [ ].
[AUTO], [400] – [3200]
 Movies
Before shooting, excessively bright or dark image areas (such as faces or
backgrounds) can be detected and automatically adjusted to the optimal
brightness.
To avoid washed-out highlights, specify Dynamic Range Correction. To
preserve image detail in shadows, specify Shadow Correct.
] is
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● ISO speed (= 73) will be adjusted to a speed within the
supported range if you have specified a value outside the
supported range indicated here.
●● Under some shooting conditions, correction may be inaccurate or
may cause images to appear grainy.
75
Shadow Correct
 Still Images  Movies
Before Use
Image Colors
Basic Guide
Automatically preserve image detail in shadows as follows.
●● Press the [ ] button, choose [ ] in the
menu, and then choose [ ] (= 29).
●● Once the setting is complete, [
displayed.
Advanced Guide
Adjusting White Balance
] is
 Still Images 1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
 Movies
By adjusting white balance (WB), you can make image colors look more
natural for the scene you are shooting.
●● Press the [ ] button, choose [ ] in the
menu, and choose the desired option
(= 29).
●● The option you configured is now
displayed.
 
Auto
Automatically sets the optimal white balance for
the shooting conditions.
Day Light
For shooting outdoors in fair weather.
Shade
For shooting in the shade.
Cloudy
For shooting in cloudy weather or at twilight.
Tungsten
For shooting under ordinary incandescent lighting.
Fluorescent
For shooting under white fluorescent lighting.
Fluorescent H
For shooting under daylight fluorescent lighting.
Flash
For shooting with the flash.
Custom
For manually setting a custom white balance
(= 77).
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
76
2 Configure advanced settings.
Custom White Balance
 Still Images  Movies
For image colors that look natural under the light in your shot, adjust white
balance to suit the light source where you are shooting. Set the white
balance under the same light source that will illuminate your shot.
●● Follow the steps in “Adjusting White
Balance” (= 76) to choose [ ] or
[ ].
●● Aim the camera at a plain white subject,
so that the entire screen is white. Press
the [ ] button.
●● The tint of the screen changes once the
white balance data has been recorded.
Before Use
●● To configure more advanced settings,
press the [
] button and adjust the
correction level by turning the [
] dial
or pressing the [ ][ ][ ][ ] buttons.
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
●● To reset the correction level, press the
[ ] button.
●● Press the [
the setting.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
] button to complete
●● The camera will retain white balance correction levels even if
you switch to another white balance option (by following steps in
“Adjusting White Balance” (= 76)), but correction levels will be
reset if you record custom white balance data.
●● Colors may look unnatural if you change camera settings after
recording white balance data.
Manually Correcting White Balance
 Still Images  Movies
You can correct white balance. This adjustment can match the effect of
using a commercially available color temperature conversion filter or colorcompensating filter.
1 Configure the setting.
●● Follow the steps in “Adjusting White
Balance” (= 76) to choose [ ].
] dial to adjust the
●● Turn the [
correction level for B and A.
●● Once the setting is complete, [ ] is
displayed.
●● B: blue; A: amber; M: magenta; G: green
●● One level of blue/amber correction is equivalent to about 7
mireds on a color temperature conversion filter. (Mired: Color
temperature unit representing color temperature conversion filter
density)
Changing Image Color Tones (My Colors)
 Still Images  Movies
Change image color tones as desired, such as converting images to sepia
or black and white.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● Press the [ ] button, choose [ ] in the
menu, and choose the desired option
(= 29).
●● The option you configured is now
displayed.
77
–
My Colors Off
Vivid
Emphasizes contrast and color saturation,
making images sharper.
Neutral
Tones down contrast and color saturation for
subdued images.
Sepia
Creates sepia tone images.
B/W
Creates black and white images.
Positive Film
Combines the effects of Vivid Blue, Vivid
Green, and Vivid Red to produce intense yet
natural-looking colors resembling images on
positive film.
Lighter Skin Tone
Lightens skin tones.
Darker Skin Tone
Darkens skin tones.
Vivid Blue
Emphasizes blues in images. Makes the sky,
ocean, and other blue subjects more vivid.
Vivid Green
Emphasizes greens in images. Makes
mountains, foliage, and other green subjects
more vivid.
Vivid Red
Emphasizes reds in images. Makes red
subjects more vivid.
Custom Color
Adjust contrast, sharpness, color saturation,
and other qualities as desired (= 78).
●● White balance (= 76) cannot be set in [ ] or [ ] modes.
●● With [ ] and [ ] modes, colors other than people’s skin tone
may change. These settings may not produce the expected
results with some skin tones.
Custom Color
Before Use
 Still Images  Movies
Choose the desired level of image contrast, sharpness, color saturation,
red, green, blue, and skin tones in a range of 1 – 5.
1 Access the setting screen.
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● Follow the steps in “Changing Image
Color Tones (My Colors)” (= 77) to
choose [ ], and then press the [ ]
button.
2 Configure the setting.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose an
option, and then specify the value by
pressing the [ ][ ] buttons.
●● For stronger/more intense effects (or
darker skin tones), adjust the value to
the right, and for weaker/lighter effects
(or lighter skin tones), adjust the value to
the left.
●● Press the [
setting.
] button to complete the
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
78
Before Use
Shooting in Manual Focus Mode
Shooting Range and Focusing
 Still Images Shooting Close-Ups (Macro)
 Still Images  Movies
To restrict the focus to subjects at close range, set the camera to [ ]. For
details on the focusing range, see “Shooting Range” (= 198).
 Movies
When focusing is not possible in AF mode, use manual focus. You can
specify the general focal position and then press the shutter button
halfway to have the camera determine the optimal focal position near the
position you specified. For details on the focusing range, see “Shooting
Range” (= 198).
1 Choose [
●● Press the [ ] button, press the [ ][ ]
buttons to choose [ ], and then press the
[ ] button.
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
].
●● Press the [ ] button, press the [ ][ ]
buttons to choose [
], and then press
the [ ] button.
●● Once the setting is complete, [ ] is
displayed.
●● [
] and the MF indicator are displayed.
2 Specify the general focal position.
] will turn
●● Referring to the on-screen MF indicator
bar (1, which shows the distance and
focal position) and the magnified display
area, press the [ ][ ] buttons to specify
the general focal position.
●● To prevent camera shake, try mounting the camera on a tripod
and shooting with the camera set to [ ] (= 44).
●● To adjust the magnification, press the [ ]
button.
●● To move the magnified display area,
press the [ ] button and then the
[ ][ ][ ][ ] buttons.
●● If the flash fires, vignetting may occur.
●● Be careful to avoid damaging the lens.
●● In the yellow bar display area below the zoom bar, [
gray and the camera will not focus.
(1)
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● Press the [ ] button to return to the
shooting screen.
3 Fine-tune the focus.
●● Press the shutter button halfway to have
the camera fine-tune the focal position
(Safety MF).
79
●● When you focus manually, the AF frame mode (= 82) is
[FlexiZone] and AF frame size (= 82) is [Normal], and these
settings cannot be changed.
●● Focusing is possible when using the digital zoom (= 40) or
digital tele-converter (= 81), or when using a TV as a display
(= 157), but the magnified display will not appear.
Focus Bracketing (Focus-BKT Mode)
 Still Images Three consecutive images are captured each time you shoot, with the
first one at the focal distance you set manually and the others at farther
and nearer focal positions determined by presets. The distance from your
specified focus can be set in three levels.
1 Choose [
●● To focus more accurately, try attaching the camera to a tripod to
stabilize it.
●● You can enlarge or hide the magnified display area by adjusting
MENU (= 30) ► [ ] tab ► [MF-Point Zoom] settings.
●● To deactivate automatic focus fine-tuning when the shutter button
is pressed halfway, choose MENU (= 30) ► [ ] tab ►
[Safety MF] ► [Off].
Easily Identifying the Focus Area (MF Peaking)
 Still Images  Movies
Edges of subjects in focus are displayed in color to make manual focusing
easier. You can adjust the colors and the sensitivity (level) of edge
detection as needed.
1 Access the setting screen.
●● Press the [
] button, choose [MF
Peaking Settings] on the [ ] tab, press
the [ ] button, choose [Peaking], and
then choose [On] (= 30).
2 Configure the setting.
●● Choose a menu item to configure, and
then choose the desired option (= 30).
Before Use
 Movies
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
].
●● Press the [ ] button, choose [ ] in the
menu, and then choose [ ] (= 29).
2 Configure the setting.
●● Press the [ ] button, and then adjust
the setting by pressing the [ ][ ] buttons
or turning the [
] dial.
●● Focus bracketing is only available in [ ] mode (= 86).
●● Continuous shooting (= 86) is not available in this mode.
●● You can also access the setting screen in step 2 by pressing the
] button in step 2 of “Shooting in Manual Focus Mode”
[
(= 79).
●● Three shots are taken, regardless of any quantity specified in [ ]
(= 44).
●● In [Blink Detection] mode (= 55), this function is only available
for the final shot.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● Colors displayed for MF peaking are not recorded in your shots.
80
Storing the Zoom or Focal Position
 Still Images Before Use
Digital Tele-Converter
 Movies
Zoom positions set with the zoom lever or focal positions set manually are
normally reset once you turn the camera off, but they can also be stored
on the camera.
Storing the Zoom Position
●● Press the [
] button, choose
[Recall Zoom/MF Settings] on the
[ ] tab, press the [ ] button, and then
choose [On] (= 30).
Storing the Focal Position
●● Follow the steps in “Storing the Zoom
Position” (= 81).
●● Choose [MF Memory], and then choose
[On] (= 30).
 Still Images  Movies
The focal length of the lens can be increased by approximately 1.6x or
2.0x. This can reduce camera shake because the shutter speed is faster
than it would be if you zoomed (including using digital zoom) in to the
same zoom factor.
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● Press the [
] button, choose
[Digital Zoom] on the [ ] tab, and then
choose the desired option (= 30).
●● The view is enlarged and the zoom factor
is displayed on the screen.
●● The digital tele-converter cannot be used with digital zoom
(= 40) or AF-point zoom (= 54).
●● The shutter speed may be equivalent when you move the zoom
] for maximum telephoto, and when
lever all the way toward [
you zoom in to enlarge the subject to the same size following step
2 in “Zooming In Closer on Subjects (Digital Zoom)” (= 40).
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● Zoom positions set in [
] Auto mode (= 42) cannot be stored.
81
Moving and Resizing AF Frames (FlexiZone)
Changing the AF Frame Mode
 Still Images  Still Images  Movies
Change the AF (auto focus) frame mode to suit the shooting conditions as
follows.
●● Press the [
] button, choose [AF
Frame] on the [ ] tab, and then choose
the desired option (= 30).
Before Use
 Movies
When you want to change the position or size of the AF frame, set the AF
frame mode to [FlexiZone] (= 82).
1 Prepare to move the AF frame.
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● Press the [ ] button. The AF frame
turns orange.
2
Move and resize the AF frame.
●● Turn the [
] dial to move the AF
frame, or press the [ ][ ][ ][ ] buttons
to move it by a smaller amount.
FlexiZone/Center
 Still Images  Movies
One AF frame is displayed. Effective for reliable focusing.
With [FlexiZone], you can move and resize the AF frame (= 82).
●● A yellow AF frame is displayed with [ ] if the camera cannot
focus when you press the shutter button halfway.
●● To compose shots so that subjects are positioned at the edge or
in a corner, first aim the camera to capture the subject in an AF
frame, and then hold the shutter button halfway down. As you
continue to hold the shutter button halfway, recompose the shot
as desired, and then press the shutter button all the way down
(Focus Lock).
●● The AF frame position is enlarged when you press the shutter
button halfway and [AF-Point Zoom] (= 54) is set to [On].
●● To return the AF frame to the original
position in the center, keep the [ ]
button held down.
●● To reduce the AF frame size, press the
] button. Press it again to restore
[
it to the original size.
3 Finish the setup process.
●● Press the [
] button.
●● AF frames are displayed at normal size when you use the digital
zoom (= 40) or digital tele-converter (= 81).
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● You can also link the Spot AE Point frame to the AF frame
(= 73).
82
2 Choose a subject to focus on.
Face Detect
 Still Images  Movies
●● Detects people’s faces, and then sets the focus, exposure (evaluative
metering only), and white balance ([ ] only).
●● After you aim the camera at the subject, a white frame is displayed
around the person’s face determined by the camera to be the main
subject, and up to two gray frames are displayed around other
detected faces.
●● When the camera detects movement, frames will follow moving
subjects, within a certain range.
●● After you press the shutter button halfway, up to nine green frames are
displayed around faces in focus.
●● If faces are not detected, or when only gray frames are displayed
(without a white frame), an AF frame is displayed in the center of
the screen when you press the shutter button halfway.
●● Examples of faces that cannot be detected:
-- Subjects that are distant or extremely close
-- Subjects that are dark or light
-- Faces in profile, at an angle, or partly hidden
●● The camera may misinterpret non-human subjects as faces.
●● No AF frames are displayed if the camera cannot focus when you
press the shutter button halfway.
Choosing Subjects to Focus On (Tracking AF)
 Still Images  Movies
Shoot after choosing a subject to focus on as follows.
1 Choose [Tracking AF].
●● Follow the steps in “Changing the AF
Frame Mode” (= 82) to choose
[Tracking AF].
●● Aim the camera so that [ ] is on the
desired subject, and then press the [
button.
Before Use
]
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● When the subject is detected, the camera
beeps and [ ] is displayed. Even if the
subject moves, the camera will continue
to track the subject within a certain range.
●● If no subject is detected, [
] is displayed.
●● To cancel tracking, press the [
again.
] button
3 Shoot.
●● Press the shutter button halfway. [ ]
changes to a blue [ ], which follows
the subject as the camera continues to
adjust the focus and exposure (Servo AF)
(= 84).
●● Press the shutter button all the way down
to shoot.
●● Even after your shot, [ ] is still displayed
and the camera continues to track the
subject.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● [Servo AF] (= 84) is set to [On] and cannot be changed.
●● Tracking may not be possible when subjects are too small or
move too rapidly, or when subject color or brightness matches
that of the background too closely.
●● [AF-Point Zoom] on the [ ] tab (= 30) is not available.
●● [ ] is displayed in the center of the
screen.
83
●● The camera can detect subjects even if you press the shutter
] button. After your shot,
button halfway without pressing the [
[ ] is displayed in the center of the screen.
●● If [Face ID] is set to [On], names will not display when registered
people are detected, but the names will be recorded in the still
images (= 47). However, a name will display if the subject
chosen to focus on is the same as a person detected with Face
ID.
 Still Images  Movies
You can change default camera operation of constantly focusing on
subjects it is aimed at, even when the shutter button is not pressed.
Instead, you can limit camera focusing to the moment you press the
shutter button halfway.
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● Press the [
] button, choose
[Continuous AF] on the [ ] tab, and then
choose [Off] (= 30).
Shooting with Servo AF
 Still Images Before Use
Changing the Focus Setting
 Movies
This mode helps avoid missing shots of subjects in motion, because the
camera continues to focus on the subject and adjust the exposure as long
as you press the shutter button halfway.
1 Configure the setting.
●● Press the [
AF] on the [
(= 30).
On
Helps avoid missing sudden photo opportunities, because
the camera constantly focuses on subjects until you press the
shutter button halfway.
Off
Conserves battery power, because the camera does not focus
constantly.
] button, choose [Servo
] tab, and then choose [On]
2 Focus.
●● The focus and exposure are maintained
where the blue AF frame is displayed while
you are pressing the shutter button halfway.
●● Focusing may not be possible in some shooting conditions.
●● In low-light conditions, Servo AF may not be activated (AF frames
may not turn blue) when you press the shutter button halfway.
In this case, the focus and exposure are set according to the
specified AF frame mode.
●● If adequate exposure cannot be obtained, shutter speeds and
aperture values are displayed in orange. Release the shutter
button, and then press it halfway again.
●● AF lock shooting is not available.
●● [AF-Point Zoom] on the [ ] tab (= 30) is not available.
●● Not available when using the self-timer (= 44).
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
84
Choosing a Person to Focus On (Face Select)
 Still Images  Movies
You can shoot after choosing a specific person’s face to focus on.
1 Prepare the camera for Face Select.
●● Set the AF frame to [Face Detect]
(= 83).
●● Aim the camera at the person’s face and
press the [ ] button.
●● After [Face Select : On] is displayed, a
face frame [ ] is displayed around the
face detected as the main subject.
●● Even if the subject moves, the face frame
[ ] follows the subject within a certain
range.
] is not
3 Choose the face to focus on.
●● To switch the face frame [
detected face, press the [
] to another
] button.
●● After you have switched the face frame
to all detected faces, [Face Select : Off]
is displayed, and the specified AF frame
mode screen is displayed again.
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Shooting with the AF Lock
 Still Images 2 Enter Face Select mode.
●● If a face is not detected, [
displayed.
●● When [Face ID] is set to [On], names of any registered people
detected are not displayed when you have selected another,
unregistered face to focus on. However, their names will be
recorded in the still images (= 47).
 Movies
The focus can be locked. After you lock the focus, the focal position will
not change even when you release your finger from the shutter button.
1 Lock the focus.
●● With the shutter button pressed halfway,
press the [ ] button.
●● The focus is now locked, and [
the MF indicator are displayed.
] and
●● To unlock the focus, after you release
the shutter button, press the [ ] button
again, and then press the [ ][ ] buttons
to choose [ ].
2 Compose the shot and shoot.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
4 Shoot.
●● Press the shutter button halfway. After the
camera focuses, [ ] changes to [ ].
●● Press the shutter button all the way down
to shoot.
85
Shooting Continuously as the Camera Keeps the
Subject in Focus
 Still Images  Movies
Shoot continuously as the camera keeps the subject in focus. For details
on the continuous shooting speed, see “Continuous Shooting Speed”
(= 198).
1 Configure the setting.
Advanced Guide
 Still Images 1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
 Movies
You can change the flash mode to match the shooting scene. For details
on the flash range, see “Flash Range” (= 198).
1 Lift the flash.
2 Configure the setting.
] is
●● Press the [ ] button, press the [ ][ ]
buttons to choose a flash mode, and then
press the [ ] button.
2 Shoot.
●● Hold the shutter button all the way down
to shoot continuously.
●● The option you configured is now
displayed.
●● The images are managed together as a
group (= 107).
●● In [ ] mode (= 59), manual focus mode (= 79), or when
AF is locked (= 85), [ ] is changed to [ ].
●● Cannot be used with the self-timer (= 44).
●● Shooting may stop momentarily or continuous shooting may slow
down depending on shooting conditions, camera settings, and the
zoom position.
●● As more shots are taken, shooting may slow down.
●● Shooting may slow down if the flash fires.
Basic Guide
Changing the Flash Mode
●● Press the [ ] button, choose [ ] in the
menu, and then choose [ ] (= 29).
●● Once the setting is complete, [
displayed.
Before Use
Flash
●● The setting screen cannot be accessed by pressing the [ ]
button when the flash is lowered. Lift the flash with your finger in
advance.
●● If the flash fires, vignetting may occur.
Auto
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
Fires automatically in low-light conditions.
On
Fires for each shot.
86
Slow Synchro
Fires to illuminate the main subject (such as people) while shooting at a
slower shutter speed to illuminate backgrounds out of flash range.
●● In [ ] mode, mount the camera on a tripod or take other
measures to keep it still and prevent camera shake. Additionally,
you should set [IS Mode] to [Off] when using a tripod or other
means to secure the camera (= 90).
●● In [ ] mode, even after the flash fires, ensure that the main
subject does not move until the shutter sound is finished playing.
Off
For shooting without the flash.
●● If a blinking [ ] icon is displayed when you press the shutter
button halfway in camera-shake inducing, low-light conditions,
mount the camera on a tripod or take other measures to keep it
still.
Before Use
Adjusting the Flash Exposure Compensation
 Still Images  Movies
Just as with regular exposure compensation (= 72), you can adjust the
flash exposure from –2 to +2 stops, in 1/3-stop increments.
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● Raise the flash, press the [ ] button and
immediately turn the [
] dial to choose
the compensation level, and then press
the [ ] button.
●● The correction level you specified is now
displayed.
●● When there is a risk of overexposure, the camera automatically
adjusts the shutter speed or aperture value during the flash shots
to reduce washed-out highlights and shoot at optimal exposure.
However, you can deactivate automatic adjustment of the shutter
speed and aperture value by accessing MENU (= 30) and
choosing [ ] tab ► [Flash Control] ► [Safety FE] ► [Off].
●● You can also configure the flash exposure compensation by
accessing MENU (= 30) and choosing [ ] tab ► [Flash
Control] ► [Flash Exp. Comp].
●● You can also access the [Built-in Flash Settings] MENU screen
(= 30) as follows (except when an optional external flash is
mounted).
-- When the flash is up, press the [ ] button and immediately
] button.
press the [
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
87
Shooting with the FE Lock
Before Use
Changing the Flash Timing
 Still Images  Movies
Just as with the AE lock (= 72), you can lock the exposure for the flash
shots.
1 Lift the flash and set the flash to [
(= 86).
 Still Images  Movies
Change the timing of the flash and shutter release as follows.
Advanced Guide
1 Access the setting screen.
]
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● Press the [
] button, choose [Flash
Control] on the [ ] tab, and then press
the [ ] button (= 30).
2 Lock the flash exposure.
2 Configure the setting.
●● Aim the camera at the subject to shoot
with the exposure locked. With the
shutter button pressed halfway, press the
[ ] button.
●● The flash fires, and when
[ ] is displayed, the flash output level is
retained.
Basic Guide
●● Choose [Shutter Sync.], and then choose
the desired option (= 30).
1st-curtain
The flash fires immediately after the shutter opens.
2nd-curtain
The flash fires immediately before the shutter closes.
●● To unlock FE, release the shutter button
and press the [ ] button again. In this
case, [ ] is no longer displayed.
3
Compose the shot and shoot.
●● After one shot, FE is unlocked and [
no longer displayed.
●● FE: Flash Exposure
] is
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
88
Shooting RAW Images
 Still Images  Movies
RAW images are “raw” (unprocessed) data, recorded with essentially no
loss of image quality from the camera’s internal image processing. Use
Digital Photo Professional (= 164) to adjust RAW images as desired
with minimal loss of image quality.
●● Press the [ ] button, choose [ ] in the
menu, and choose the desired option
(= 29).
●● When transferring RAW images (or RAW and JPEG images
recorded together) to a computer, always use the dedicated
software (= 164).
●● Digital zoom (= 40), date stamps (= 45), and red-eye
reduction (= 52) are set to [Off] in [ ] and [ ] modes.
Additionally, noise reduction level (= 74), i-Contrast (= 75)
and My Colors (= 77) cannot be configured.
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● The file extension for JPEG images is .JPG, and the extension for
RAW images is .CR2.
Records JPEG images. JPEG images are processed in the camera
for optimal image quality and compressed to reduce file size.
However, the compression process is irreversible, and images
cannot be restored to their original, unprocessed state. Image
processing may also cause some loss of image quality.
Records RAW images. RAW images are “raw” (unprocessed)
data, recorded with essentially no loss of image quality from the
camera’s image processing. The data cannot be used in this
state for viewing on a computer or printing. You must first use the
software (Digital Photo Professional) to convert images to ordinary
JPEG or TIFF files. Images can be adjusted with minimal loss of
image quality.
For details on resolution and the number of shots that will fit on a
card, see “Number of Shots per Memory Card” (= 197).
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
Records two images, both a RAW image and a JPEG image, for
each shot.
The JPEG image can be viewed on a computer or printed without
using the software.
89
Before Use
Changing the IS Mode Settings
Other Settings
 Still Images Changing the Compression Ratio (Image Quality)
 Still Images  Movies
1 Access the setting screen.
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● Press the [
] button, choose [IS
Settings] on the [ ] tab, and then press
the [ ] button (= 30).
 Movies
Choose from two compression ratios, [ ] (Super Fine) and [ ] (Fine), as
follows. For guidelines on how many shots at each compression ratio can
fit on a memory card, see “Number of Shots per Memory Card” (= 197).
2 Configure the setting.
●● Press the [ ] button, choose [ ] in the
menu, and choose the desired option
(= 29).
●● Choose [IS Mode], and then choose the
desired option (= 30).
Continuous
Optimal image stabilization for the shooting conditions is
automatically applied (Intelligent IS) (= 39).
Shoot Only*
Image stabilization is active only at the moment of
shooting.
Off
Deactivates image stabilization.
* The setting is changed to [Continuous] for movie recording.
●● If image stabilization cannot prevent camera shake, mount the
camera on a tripod or take other measures to hold it still. In this
case, set [IS Mode] to [Off].
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
90
Shooting Movies with Subjects at the Same Size
Shown before Shooting
 Still Images  Movies
Normally, once movie recording begins, the image display area changes
and subjects are enlarged to allow for correction of significant camera
shake. To shoot subjects at the same size shown before shooting, you can
choose not to reduce significant camera shake.
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● Follow the steps in “Changing the IS
Mode Settings” (= 90) to access the
[IS Settings] screen.
●● Choose [Dynamic IS], and then choose
[2] (= 30).
●● You can also set [IS Mode] to [Off], so that subjects are recorded
at the same size shown before shooting.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
91
5
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Specific Shutter Speeds ([Tv] Mode)
 Still Images  Movies
Set your preferred shutter speed before shooting as follows. The camera
automatically adjusts the aperture value to suit your shutter speed.
For details on available shutter speeds, see “Shutter Speed” (= 199).
1 Enter [
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
] mode.
●● Set the mode dial to [
Take smarter, more sophisticated shots, and customize the camera for
your shooting style
Before Use
].
2 Set the shutter speed.
●● Instructions in this chapter apply to the camera as set to the respective
mode.
●● Turn the [
speed.
] dial to set the shutter
●● In conditions requiring slower shutter speeds, there may be a
delay before you can shoot again, as the camera processes
images to reduce noise.
●● When shooting at low shutter speeds on a tripod, you should set
[IS Mode] to [Off] (= 90).
●● With shutter speeds of 1.3 seconds or slower, ISO speed is [ ]
and cannot be changed.
●● Orange display of aperture values when you press the shutter
button halfway indicates that the settings deviate from standard
exposure. Adjust the shutter speed until the aperture value is
displayed in white, or use safety shift (= 93).
●● [
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
]: Time value
92
Specific Aperture Values ([Av] Mode)
 Still Images  Movies
Set your preferred aperture value before shooting as follows. The camera
automatically adjusts the shutter speed to suit your aperture value.
For details on available aperture values, see “Aperture” (= 199).
1 Enter [
] mode.
●● Set the mode dial to [
].
 Still Images 1 Enter [
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
] mode.
].
●● Press the [ ] button, choose adjustment
of shutter speed (1) or aperture value (2),
and turn the [
] dial to specify a value.
] dial to set the aperture
●● [
]: Aperture value (size of the opening made by the iris in the
lens)
] and [
] modes, you
●● To avoid exposure problems in [
can have the camera automatically adjust the shutter speed or
aperture value, even when standard exposure cannot otherwise
] button and set [Safety Shift] on
be obtained. Press the [
the [ ] tab to [On] (= 30).
However, safety shift is disabled when the flash fires.
 Movies
2 Configure the setting.
2 Set the aperture value.
●● Orange display of shutter speeds when you press the shutter
button halfway indicates that the settings deviate from standard
exposure. Adjust the aperture value until the shutter speed is
displayed in white, or use safety shift (see below).
Basic Guide
Follow these steps before shooting to set your preferred shutter speed
and aperture value to obtain the desired exposure.
For details on available shutter speeds and aperture values, see “Shutter
Speed” (= 199) and “Aperture” (= 199).
●● Set the mode dial to [
●● Turn the [
value.
Before Use
Specific Shutter Speeds and
Aperture Values ([M] Mode)
(1)
●● An exposure level mark (4) based on
your specified value is shown on the
exposure level indicator for comparison to
the standard exposure level (3).
(2)
(3)
●● [ ] or [ ] is displayed when the difference
from standard exposure exceeds 2 stops.
(4)
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
93
●● After you set the shutter speed or aperture value, the exposure
level may change if you adjust the zoom or recompose the shot.
●● Screen brightness may change depending on your specified
shutter speed or aperture value. However, screen brightness
remains the same when the flash is up and the mode is set to [ ].
●● With shutter speeds of 1.3 seconds or slower, ISO speed is [ ]
and cannot be changed.
●● [ ]: Manual
●● Calculation of standard exposure is based on the specified
metering method (= 72).
Before Use
Adjusting the Flash Output
 Still Images Choose from the three flash levels in [
1 Enter [
 Movies
] mode.
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
] mode.
●● Set the mode dial to [
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
].
2 Specify the flash mode.
●● Press the [
Control] on the [
the [ ] button.
] button, choose [Flash
] tab, and then press
●● In [Flash Mode], choose [Manual]
(= 30).
3 Configure the setting.
●● Raise the flash, press the [ ] button and
immediately turn the [
] dial to choose
the flash level, and then press the [ ]
button.
●● Once the setting is complete, the flash
output level is displayed.
]: Medium, [
]:
[ ]: Minimum, [
Maximum
●● You can also set the flash level by accessing MENU (= 30)
and choosing [ ] tab ► [Flash Control] ► [Flash Output].
●● You can also access the [Built-in Flash Settings] MENU screen
(= 30) as follows (except when an optional external flash is
mounted).
-- When the flash is up, press the [ ] button and immediately
] button.
press the [
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
94
Recording Movies at Specific Shutter Speeds and
Aperture Values
 Still Images  Movies
Set your preferred shutter speed, aperture value, and ISO speed.
For details on available shutter speeds, aperture values, and ISO speeds,
see “Specific Shutter Speeds” (= 92), “Specific Aperture Values”
(= 93), and “Changing the ISO Speed” (= 73).
1 Enter [
] mode.
●● Set the mode dial to [
].
Changing Settings during Recording
Settings can also be adjusted while you are recording a movie, by
following step 2 in “Recording Movies at Specific Shutter Speeds and
Aperture Values” (= 95). However, any changes in brightness are
recorded in the movie.
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● To make the sound of the [
] dial quieter, press the [ ][ ]
buttons and adjust the setting.
●● You can switch between adjusting the shutter speed, aperture
value, ISO speed, and focal position during MF (= 79) movie
recording each time you press the [ ] button. Press the [ ][ ]
buttons to configure these settings.
●● Press the [ ] button, choose [ ] in the
menu, and then choose [ ] (= 29).
2 Configure the setting.
●● Press the [ ] button to choose shutter
speed, aperture value, or ISO speed,
and then turn the [
] dial to choose
a value.
●● Some shutter speeds may cause flickering on the screen when
recording under fluorescent or LED lighting, which may be recorded.
●● With [ ], the exposure level mark moves when the shutter button
is pressed halfway, showing the difference from the standard
exposure level.
●● With settings other than [ ], an exposure level mark based on
your specified shutter speed and aperture value is shown for
comparison to the standard exposure level.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
95
Customization for Shooting Styles
Customizing Display Information
 Still Images ●● Press the [
] button, choose
[Custom Display] on the [ ] tab, and
then press the [ ] button (= 30).
●● Press the [ ][ ][ ][ ] buttons to choose
an item, and then press the [ ] button.
Items you choose for display are labeled
with [ ].
●● Selected items (labeled with a [
be included in display.
Displays a reference grid.
]) will
Displays a histogram (= 103) in [ ], [
[ ], [ ], [ ], and [ ] modes.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● Grid lines are not recorded in your shots.
 Still Images  Movies
You can quickly and easily activate functions that you assign to the [
button, movie button (
button), or [ ] button.
]
●● Press the [
] button, choose [Set
Shortcut button], [Set
button] or [Set
button] on the [ ] tab, and then
press the [ ] button (= 30).
2 Configure the setting.
●● Press the [ ][ ][ ][ ] buttons to choose
a function to assign, and then press the
[ ] button.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
3 Use the assigned function as
Electronic Level Displays the electronic level (= 54).
Histogram
Advanced Guide
1 Access the setting screen.
2 Configure the setting.
Displays shooting information (= 180).
Basic Guide
Assigning Functions to Buttons
1 Access the setting screen.
Grid Lines
Before Use
 Movies
Set the number of custom displays (= 28) and what information is
displayed in each display when the [ ] button is pressed in shooting
screen.
Shooting Info
●● Settings will not be saved if you press the shutter button halfway
and return to the shooting screen from the custom display settings
screen.
●● Grayed-out items can also be specified, but they may not be
displayed in some shooting modes.
], [
],
needed.
●● To activate an assigned function, press
the button you assigned it to.
96
●● To restore default settings, choose [ ] in [Set Shortcut button],
button], and [ ] in [Set
button].
[ ] in [Set
●● Icons labeled with [ ] indicate that the function is not available in
the current shooting mode or under current function conditions.
●● With [ ] or [ ], each press of the assigned button records
white balance data (= 77), and the white balance setting
changes to [ ] or [ ].
], each press of the assigned button adjusts and locks
●● With [
] is then displayed.
the focus. [
●● With [ ], pressing the assigned button deactivates screen
display. To restore the display, do any of the following.
-- Press any button other than the power button
-- Hold the camera in another orientation
-- Raise or lower the flash
●● You can still record movies in [ ], [ ], [ ], or [ ] mode even
if you assign a function to the movie button.
Before Use
Customizing the FUNC. Menu
(FUNC. Menu Layout)
Basic Guide
The display of FUNC. menu items can be customized. Functions not
shown on this menu will be available on the [ ] tab of the menu screen.
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Choosing Items to Include in the Menu
 Still Images  Movies
1 Access the setting screen.
●● Press the [
] button, choose
[FUNC. Menu Layout] on the [ ] tab,
and then press the [ ] button (= 30).
2 Choose icons to include in the
menu.
●● Press the [ ][ ][ ][ ] buttons and press
the [ ] button to choose icons to include
in the FUNC. menu. Selected icons are
marked with a [ ].
●● Selected items (labeled with a [
be included in display.
]) will
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● Items without a [ ] will be available on
the [ ] tab of the menu screen.
3 Configure the setting.
●● Press the [
] button, press the
[ ][ ] buttons to choose [OK], and then
press the [ ] button.
97
●● The screen in step 2 can also be accessed by holding down the
[ ] button when the FUNC. menu is displayed.
●● Items that you remove from the FUNC. menu, add to My Menu
(= 99), and then add to the FUNC. menu again will be
removed from My Menu.
Rearranging Menu Items
1 Access the setting screen.
●● On the screen in step 2 of “Choosing
Items to Include in the Menu” (= 97),
press the [ ] button.
●● Press the [ ] or [ ] button to choose an
icon to move. Press the [ ][ ] buttons
to choose the new position, and then
press the [ ] or [ ] button.
2 Configure the setting.
●● Press the [
] button, press the
[ ][ ] buttons to choose [OK], and then
press the [ ] button.
Before Use
Saving Shooting Settings
 Still Images  Movies
Save commonly used shooting modes and your configured function
settings for reuse. To access saved settings later, simply turn the mode
dial to [ ] or [
]. Even settings that are usually cleared when you
switch shooting modes or turn the camera off (such as self-timer settings)
can be retained this way.
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Settings that can be saved
●● Shooting mode ([ ], [
●● Items set in [ ], [
], [
], [
], or [
], or [
])
] modes (= 72 – = 93)
●● Shooting menu settings
●● Zoom positions
●● Manual focus positions (= 79)
●● My Menu settings (= 99)
1 Enter a shooting mode with settings
you want to save, and change the
settings as desired.
2 Configure the setting.
●● Press the [
] button, choose [Save
Settings] on the [ ] tab, and then press
the [ ] button.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
3 Save the settings.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose the
destination, and then press the [ ]
button.
98
●● To edit saved settings (except their shooting mode), choose [
]
], change the settings, and then repeat steps 2 – 3. These
or [
setting details are not applied in other shooting modes.
 Still Images ●● To clear information you have saved to [
] or [
] and restore
] or [
] and choose
default values, turn the mode dial to [
[Reset All] (= 152).
Before Use
Saving Commonly Used Shooting Menu Items
(My Menu)
Basic Guide
 Movies
Advanced Guide
You can save up to five commonly used shooting menu items on the [ ]
tab. By customizing the [ ] tab, you can access to these items quickly
from a single screen.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
1 Access the setting screen.
●● Press the [
] button, choose [My
Menu settings] on the [ ] tab, and then
press the [ ] button (= 30).
2 Configure the setting.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose
[Select items], and then press the [ ]
button.
●● Choose up to five menu items to save by
pressing the [ ][ ] buttons, and then
press the [ ] button.
●● [
] is displayed.
●● To cancel saving, press the [
[ ] is no longer displayed.
●● Press the [
] button.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
] button.
99
3 Rearrange menu items, as needed.
Before Use
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose
[Sort], and then press the [ ] button.
Basic Guide
●● Choose a menu item to move by pressing
the [ ][ ] buttons, and then press the
[ ] button.
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to change the
order, and then press the [ ] button.
●● Press the [
] button.
●● Grayed-out items in step 2 can also be specified, but they may
not be available in some shooting modes.
●● To make My Menu immediately accessible by pressing the
] button in Shooting mode, choose [Set default view] and
[
press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose [Yes].
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
100
6
 Still Images  Movies
After shooting images or movies, you can view them on the screen as
follows.
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
1 Enter Playback mode.
Playback Mode
●● Press the [
Have fun reviewing your shots, and browse or edit them in many ways
●● To prepare the camera for these operations, press the [
enter Playback mode.
Before Use
Viewing
] button to
●● It may not be possible to play back or edit images that were
renamed or already edited on a computer, or images from other
cameras.
] button.
●● Your last shot is displayed.
2 Browse through your images.
●● To view the previous image, press the [ ]
button. To view the next image, press the
[ ] button.
●● To access this screen (Scroll Display
mode), press and hold the [ ][ ] buttons
for at least one second. In this mode,
press the [ ][ ] buttons to browse
through images.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● To return to single-image display, press
the [ ] button.
●● To browse images grouped by shooting
date, press the [ ][ ] buttons in Scroll
Display mode.
101
●● Movies are identified by a [
To play movies, go to step 3.
] icon.
Before Use
Switching Display Modes
 Still Images 3
Play movies.
●● To start playback, press the [ ] button to
access the movie control panel, press the
[ ][ ] buttons to choose [ ], and then
press the [ ] button again.
 Movies
Press the [ ] button to view other information on the screen, or to hide
the information. For details on the information displayed, see “Playback
(Detailed Information Display)” (= 181).
Open the screen to activate it when the camera is on. This will deactivate
the viewfinder. Similarly, close the screen (facing the camera body) to
deactivate it and activate the viewfinder (= 20).
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
No Information Display
4 Adjust the volume.
●● Press the [
volume.
][
] buttons to adjust the
●● To adjust the volume when the volume
indicator (1) is no longer displayed, press
the [ ][ ] buttons.
(1)
Simple Information Display
5 Pause playback.
●● To pause or resume playback, press the
[ ] button.
●● After the movie is finished, [
displayed.
Detailed Information Display
] is
●● To switch to Shooting mode from Playback mode, press the
shutter button halfway.
] tab
●● To deactivate Scroll Display, choose MENU (= 30) ► [
► [Scroll Display] ► [Off].
●● To have the most recent shot displayed when you enter Playback
] tab ► [Resume] ►
mode, choose MENU (= 30) ► [
[Last shot].
●● To change the transition shown between images, access MENU
] tab ►
(= 30) and choose your desired effect on the [
[Transition Effect].
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
RGB Histogram, GPS Information
Display
●● Switching display modes is not possible while the camera is
connected via Wi-Fi to devices other than printers.
102
Overexposure Warning (for Image Highlights)
 Still Images  Movies
Washed-out highlights in the image flash on the screen in detailed
information display (= 102).
Histogram
 Still Images  Movies
●● The graph in detailed information display
(= 102) is a histogram showing the
distribution of brightness in the image.
The horizontal axis represents the degree
of brightness, and the vertical axis, how
much of the image is at each level of
brightness. Viewing the histogram is a
way to check exposure.
●● The histogram can also be accessed
while shooting (= 96, = 180).
●● Using a smartphone connected to the
camera via Wi-Fi, you can geotag images
on the camera, adding information such
as latitude, longitude, and elevation
(= 141). You can review this information
in the GPS information display.
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● Latitude, longitude, elevation, and UTC
(shooting date and time) are listed from
top to bottom.
●● [---] is shown instead of numerical values for items not available
on your smartphone or items not recorded correctly.
●● UTC: Coordinated Universal Time, essentially the same as
Greenwich Mean Time
●● GPS information display is not available for images that lack this
information.
RGB Histogram, GPS Information Display
 Still Images (1)
 Movies
●● The RGB histogram (1) shows the
distribution of shades of red, green, and
blue in an image. The horizontal axis
represents R, G, or B brightness, and the
vertical axis, how much of the image is
at that level of brightness. Viewing this
histogram enables you to check image
color characteristics.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
103
Viewing by Date
Viewing Short Movies Created When Shooting
Still Images (Digest Movies)
 Still Images View digest movies recorded automatically in [
day of still image shooting as follows.
 Movies
] mode (= 35) on a
1 Choose an image.
●● Still images shot in [
labeled with an [
Before Use
Digest movies can be viewed by date.
Basic Guide
1 Choose a movie.
●● Press the [
] button, choose [List/
Play Digest Movies] on the [
] tab, and
then choose a date (= 30).
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
2 Play the movie.
] mode are
] icon.
●● Choose a still image labeled with
] and press the [ ] button.
[
●● Press the [
] button to start playback.
Checking People Detected in Face ID
 Still Images 2 Play the movie.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose [OK]
(= 29).
●● The movie recorded automatically on the
day of still image shooting is played back,
from the beginning.
●● After a moment, [
] will no longer be displayed when
you are using the camera with information display deactivated
(= 102).
 Movies
If you switch the camera to simple information display mode (= 102),
the names of up to five detected people registered in Face ID (= 47)
will be displayed.
●● Press the [ ] button several times until
simple information display is activated,
and then press the [ ][ ] buttons to
choose an image.
●● Names will be displayed on detected
people.
●● If you prefer not to have names displayed on images shot using
] tab ► [Face ID Info]
Face ID, choose MENU (= 30) ► [
► [Name Display] ► [Off].
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
104
 Still Images Navigating through Images in an Index
 Still Images  Movies
By displaying multiple images in an index, you can quickly find the images
you are looking for.
1 Display images in an index.
●● Move the zoom lever toward [ ] to
display images in an index. Moving the
lever again will increase the number of
images shown.
●● To display fewer images, move the zoom
lever toward [ ]. Fewer images are
shown each time you move the lever.
2 Choose an image.
●● Press the [
an image.
][
Before Use
Finding Images Matching Specified Conditions
Browsing and Filtering Images
][ ][ ] buttons to choose
●● An orange frame is displayed around the
selected image.
●● Press the [ ] button to view the selected
image in single-image display.
●● To deactivate the 3D display effect (shown if you hold down the
] tab ► [Index
[ ][ ] buttons), choose MENU (= 30) ► [
Effect] ► [Off].
 Movies
Find desired images quickly on a memory card full of images by filtering
image display according to your specified conditions. You can also protect
(= 110) or delete (= 112) these images all at once.
Name
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Displays images of a registered person (= 47).
People
Displays images with detected faces.
Date
Displays the images shot on a specific date.
Favorites
Displays images tagged as favorites (= 115).
Still image/
Movie
Basic Guide
Displays only still images or movies.
Displays still images, movies, or movies shot in [
mode (= 35).
]
1 Choose [Image Search].
●● Press the [
] button, and then
choose [Image Search] on the [
] tab
(= 30).
2 Choose the first condition for image
display or navigation.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● When [ ] or [ ] is selected, you can
view only images matching this condition
by pressing the [ ][ ] buttons. To perform
an action for all of these images together,
press the [ ] button and go to step 3.
105
3 Choose the second condition and
check the images found.
●● To switch to filtered image display, press
the [ ] button and go to step 4.
●● When you have selected [ ] as the first
condition, press the [ ] button, and press
the [ ][ ][ ][ ] buttons on the next
screen to choose a person.
4 View the filtered images.
●● Images matching your conditions are
displayed in yellow frames. To view only
these images, press the [ ][ ] buttons.
●● To cancel filtered display, press the [
button.
]
●● When the camera has found no corresponding images for some
conditions, those conditions will not be available. Note that [ ] is
not available unless people are registered (= 47).
●● To show or hide information, press the [ ] button in step 3.
●● Options for viewing the images found (in step 3) include
“Navigating through Images in an Index” (= 105), “Magnifying
Images” (= 108), and “Viewing Slideshows” (= 109). You can
also apply image operations to all images found, by choosing
[Protect All Images in Search] in “Protecting Images” (= 110) or
[Select All Images in Search] in “Erasing Multiple Images at Once”
(= 113), “Adding Images to the Print List (DPOF)” (= 170), or
“Adding Images to a Photobook” (= 172).
●● If you edit images and save them as new images (= 116 –
= 120), a message is displayed, and the images that were
found are no longer shown.
Before Use
Using the Front Dial to Jump between Images
Basic Guide
Jump to Favorites
Displays images tagged as favorites (= 115).
Jump Shot Date
Jumps to the first image in each group of
images that were shot on the same date.
Jump 10 Images
Jumps by 10 images at a time.
Jump 100 Images
Jumps by 100 images at a time.
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
1 Choose a condition.
●● Choose a condition (or jump method)
in single-image display by turning the
[
] dial and then pressing the [ ][
buttons.
]
2 View images matching your
specified condition, or jump by the
specified amount.
●● Turn the [
] dial to view only images
matching the condition or jump by the
specified number of images forward or
back.
●● Turning the [
] dial when browsing images in index display
will jump to the previous or next image according to the jump
method chosen in single-image display. However, if you have
chosen [ ] or [ ], the jump method will be switched to [ ].
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
106
Viewing Individual Images in a Group
 Still Images Editing Face ID Information
 Movies
Images shot consecutively (= 46, = 58, = 86) or in [
] or [ ]
mode (= 57, = 58) are displayed as a group but can also be viewed
individually.
1
Choose a grouped image.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose an
image labeled with [
], and then
press the [ ] button.
If you notice that a name is incorrect during playback, you can change it
or erase it.
However, you cannot add names for people who are not detected by Face
ID (names are not displayed), and for people whose names have been
erased.
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Changing Names
1 Access the setting screen.
2 View images in the group
individually.
●● Pressing the [ ][ ] buttons will display
only images in the group.
●● Pressing the [ ] button will display
[Display all images]. Press [ ] to cancel
group playback.
●● During group playback (step 2), you can browse through images
quickly “Navigating through Images in an Index” (= 105) and
magnify them “Magnifying Images” (= 108). By choosing [All
Images in Group] for “Protecting Images” (= 110), “Erasing
Multiple Images at Once” (= 113), “Adding Images to the Print
List (DPOF)” (= 170), or “Adding Images to a Photobook”
(= 172), all images in the group can be manipulated at once.
●● To ungroup images so that they are displayed only as single still
] tab ► [Group Images]
images, choose MENU (= 30) ► [
► [Off]. However, grouped images cannot be ungrouped during
individual playback.
] mode, the simultaneous display after step 2 in “Enjoying
●● In [
a Variety of Images from Each Shot (Creative Shot)” (= 57) is
only shown immediately after you shoot.
●● Press the [
] button and choose
[Face ID Info] on the [
] tab (= 30).
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose [Edit
ID Info], and then press the [ ] button.
2 Choose an image.
●● Following the procedure in “Checking
People Detected in Face ID” (= 104),
choose an image and press the [ ]
button.
●● An orange frame is displayed around the
selected face. When multiple names are
displayed in an image, press the [ ][ ]
buttons to choose the name to change,
and press the [ ] button.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
3 Choose the editing option.
●● Press the [ ][ ][ ][ ] buttons to choose
[Overwrite], and then press the [ ]
button.
107
4 Choose the name of the person to
overwrite with.
●● Follow step 2 in “Overwriting and Adding
Face Information” (= 50) to choose
the name of the person you want to
overwrite with.
Before Use
Image Viewing Options
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
Magnifying Images
 Still Images Erasing Names
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
 Movies
1 Magnify an image.
●● Following step 3 in “Changing Names”
(= 107), choose [Erase] and press the
[ ] button.
●● Moving the zoom lever toward [ ] will
zoom in and magnify the image, and
[
] is displayed. You can magnify
images up to about 10x by continuing to
hold the zoom lever.
●● After [Erase?] is displayed, press the
[ ][ ] buttons to choose [OK], and then
press the [ ] button.
●● The approximate position of the displayed
area (1) is shown for reference.
●● To zoom out, move the zoom lever
toward [ ]. You can return to singleimage display by continuing to hold it.
(1)
2 Move the display position and
switch images as needed.
●● To move the display position, press the
[ ][ ][ ][ ] buttons.
] is displayed, you can switch
●● While [
] by pressing the [ ] button. To
to [
switch to other images while zoomed,
press the [ ][ ] buttons. Press the
[ ] button again to restore the original
setting.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● You can return to single-image display from magnified display by
] button.
pressing the [
108
Changing Slideshow Settings
Viewing Slideshows
 Still Images  Movies
Automatically play back images from a memory card as follows.
1 Access the setting screen.
●● Press the [
] button, and then
choose [Slideshow] on the [
] tab
(= 30).
You can set up slideshows to repeat, and you can change the transitions
between images and the display duration of each image.
1 Access the setting screen.
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
●● Press the [
] button, and then
choose [Slideshow] on the [
] tab
(= 30).
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
2 Configure the settings.
●● Choose a menu item to configure, and
then choose the desired option (= 30).
2 Configure the setting.
●● Choose a menu item to configure, and
then choose the desired option (= 30).
●● To start the slideshow with your settings,
choose [Start] and press the [ ] button.
●● To return to the menu screen, press the
] button.
[
3 Start automatic playback.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose
[Start], and then press the [ ] button.
●● The slideshow will start after [Loading
image] is displayed for a few seconds.
●● Press the [
slideshow.
] button to stop the
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● The camera’s power-saving functions (= 26) are deactivated
during slideshows.
●● To pause or resume slideshows, press the [ ] button.
●● You can switch to other images during playback by pressing the
[ ][ ] buttons. For fast-forward or fast-rewind, hold the [ ][ ]
buttons down.
109
Auto Playback of Related Images (Smart Shuffle)
 Still Images  Movies
Based on the current image, the camera offers four images that you may
wish to view. After you choose to view one of those images, the camera
offers four more images. This is an enjoyable way to play back images in
an unexpected order. Try this feature after you have taken many shots, in
many kinds of scenes.
1 Choose Smart Shuffle.
●● Press the [
] button, choose [Smart
Shuffle] on the [
] tab, and then press
the [ ] button (= 30).
●● Four candidate images are displayed.
2 Choose an image.
●● Press the [ ][ ][ ][ ] buttons to choose
the image you want to view next.
●● Your chosen image is displayed in the
center, surrounded by the next four
candidate images.
●● For full-screen display of the center
image, press the [ ] button. To restore
the original display, press the [ ] button
again.
] button to restore
●● Press the [
single-image display.
●● Smart Shuffle is not available in the following cases:
-- There are less than 50 shots taken with this camera
-- An unsupported image is currently displayed
-- Images are shown in filtered display (= 105)
-- During group playback (= 107)
Before Use
Protecting Images
 Still Images  Movies
Protect important images to prevent accidental erasure by the camera
(= 112).
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Choosing a Selection Method
1 Access the setting screen.
●● Press the [
] button and choose
[Protect] on the [
] tab (= 30).
2 Choose a selection method.
●● Choose a menu item and an option as
desired (= 30).
●● To return to the menu screen, press the
] button.
[
●● Protected images on a memory card will be erased if you format
the card (= 148, = 149).
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● Protected images cannot be erased using the camera’s erasure
function. To erase them this way, first cancel protection.
110
Choosing Images Individually
Before Use
Selecting a Range
Basic Guide
1 Choose [Select].
●● Following step 2 in “Choosing a Selection
Method” (= 110), choose [Select] and
press the [ ] button.
2 Choose an image.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose an
image, and then press the [ ] button.
[ ] is displayed.
1 Choose [Select Range].
●● Following step 2 in “Choosing a Selection
Method” (= 110), choose [Select
Range] and press the [ ] button.
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
2 Choose a starting image.
●● Press the [
] button.
●● To cancel selection, press the [ ] button
again. [ ] is no longer displayed.
●● Repeat this process to specify other
images.
3
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose an
image, and then press the [ ] button.
Protect the image.
●● Press the [
] button. A confirmation
message is displayed.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose [OK],
and then press the [ ] button.
●● Images will not be protected if you switch to Shooting mode or
turn the camera off before finishing the setup process in step 3.
3 Choose an ending image.
●● Press the [ ] button to choose [Last
image], and then press the [ ] button.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose an
image, and then press the [ ] button.
●● Images before the first image cannot be
selected as the last image.
111
4 Protect the images.
●● Press the [ ] button to choose [Protect],
and then press the [ ] button.
Before Use
Erasing Images
 Still Images  Movies
Advanced Guide
You can choose and erase unneeded images one by one. Be careful
when erasing images, because they cannot be recovered. However,
protected images (= 110) cannot be erased.
●● To cancel protection for groups of images, choose [Unlock] in
step 4.
Protecting All Images at Once
1 Choose [Protect All Images].
●● Following step 2 in “Choosing a Selection
Method” (= 110), choose [Protect All
Images] and press the [ ] button.
2 Protect the images.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose [OK],
and then press the [ ] button.
Basic Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
1 Choose an image to erase.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose an
image.
2 Erase the image.
●● Press the [ ] button.
●● After [Erase?] is displayed, press the
[ ][ ] buttons to choose [Erase], and
then press the [ ] button.
●● The current image is now erased.
●● To cancel erasure, press the [ ][ ]
buttons to choose [Cancel], and then
press the [ ] button.
●● Pressing the [ ] button while [ ] images are displayed will give
], or [Erase
you the option of choosing [Erase ], [Erase
for deletion.
]
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
Clearing All Protection at Once
You can clear protection from all images at once.
To clear protection, choose [Unprotect All Images] in step 1 of “Protecting
All Images at Once”, and then complete step 2.
112
2 Choose an image.
Erasing Multiple Images at Once
●● Once you choose an image following
step 2 in “Choosing Images Individually”
(= 111), [ ] is displayed.
You can choose multiple images to erase at once. Be careful when
erasing images, because they cannot be recovered. However, protected
images (= 110) cannot be erased.
●● To cancel selection, press the [ ] button
again. [ ] is no longer displayed.
Choosing a Selection Method
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● Repeat this process to specify other
images.
1 Access the setting screen.
3
●● Press the [
] button, and then
choose [Erase] on the [
] tab (= 30).
Erase the image.
●● Press the [
] button. A confirmation
message is displayed.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose [OK],
and then press the [ ] button.
2 Choose a selection method.
Selecting a Range
●● Choose a menu item and an option as
desired (= 30).
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose a
selection method, and then press the [
button.
1 Choose [Select Range].
]
●● To return to the menu screen, press the
] button.
[
Choosing Images Individually
1
Choose [Select].
●● Following step 2 in “Choosing a Selection
Method” (= 113), choose [Select] and
press the [ ] button.
●● Following step 2 in “Choosing a Selection
Method” (= 113), choose [Select
Range] and press the [ ] button.
2 Choose images.
●● Follow steps 2 – 3 in “Selecting a Range”
(= 111) to specify images.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
3 Erase the images.
●● Press the [ ] button to choose [Erase],
and then press the [ ] button.
113
Specifying All Images at Once
1 Choose [Select All Images].
●● Following step 2 in “Choosing a Selection
Method” (= 113), choose [Select All
Images] and press the [ ] button.
2
Erase the images.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose [OK],
and then press the [ ] button.
Before Use
Rotating Images
 Still Images  Movies
Change the orientation of images and save them as follows.
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1 Choose [Rotate].
●● Press the [
[Rotate] on the [
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
] button and choose
] tab (= 30).
2 Rotate the image.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose an
image.
●● The image is rotated 90° each time you
press the [ ] button.
●● To return to the menu screen, press the
] button.
[
●● Rotation is not possible when [Auto Rotate] is set to [Off]
(= 115).
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
114
Deactivating Auto Rotation
Follow these steps to deactivate automatic image rotation, which rotates
images based on the current camera orientation.
●● Press the [
Rotate] on the [
[Off] (= 30).
Before Use
Tagging Images as Favorites
] button, choose [Auto
] tab, and then choose
 Still Images  Movies
You can organize images by tagging them as favorites. By choosing a
category in filtered playback, you can restrict the following operations to
all of those images.
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● “Viewing” (= 101), “Viewing Slideshows” (= 109), “Protecting
Images” (= 110), “Erasing Images” (= 112), “Adding Images to
the Print List (DPOF)” (= 170), “Adding Images to a Photobook”
(= 172)
1 Choose [Favorites].
●● Images cannot be rotated (= 114) when you set [Auto Rotate]
to [Off]. Additionally, images already rotated will be displayed in
the original orientation.
●● In Smart Shuffle (= 110) mode, even if [Auto Rotate] is set
to [Off], images shot vertically will be displayed vertically, and
rotated images will be displayed in the rotated orientation.
●● Press the [
] button and choose
[Favorites] on the [
] tab (= 30).
2 Choose an image.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose an
image, and then press the [ ] button.
[ ] is displayed.
●● To untag the image, press the [ ] button
again. [ ] is no longer displayed.
●● Repeat this process to choose additional
images.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
3 Finish the setup process.
●● Press the [
] button. A confirmation
message is displayed.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose [OK],
and then press the [ ] button.
115
●● Images will not be tagged as favorites if you switch to Shooting
mode or turn the camera off before finishing the setup process in
step 3.
●● Favorite images will have a three-star rating (
)
when transferred to computers running Windows 8 or Windows 7.
(Does not apply to movies or RAW images.)
Before Use
Editing Still Images
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
●● Image editing (= 116 – = 119) is only available when the
memory card has sufficient free space.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Resizing Images
 Still Images  Movies
Save a copy of images at a lower resolution.
1 Choose [Resize].
●● Press the [
] button and choose
[Resize] on the [
] tab (= 30).
2 Choose an image.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose an
image, and then press the [ ] button.
3 Choose an image size.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose the
size, and then press the [ ] button.
●● [Save new image?] is displayed.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
4 Save the new image.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose [OK],
and then press the [ ] button.
●● The image is now saved as a new file.
116
5 Review the new image.
(1)
(2)
(3)
3 Adjust the cropping area.
●● Press the [
] button. [Display new
image?] is displayed.
●● A frame is displayed around the portion of
the image to be cropped (1).
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose [Yes],
and then press the [ ] button.
●● The original image is shown in the upper
left, and a preview of the image as
cropped (2) is shown in the lower right.
You can also see the resolution after
cropping (3).
●● The saved image is now displayed.
●● Editing is not possible for images shot at a resolution of [ ]
(= 52).
●● RAW images cannot be edited.
●● To resize the frame, move the zoom
lever.
●● Images cannot be resized to a higher resolution.
●● To change the frame orientation, press
the [ ] button.
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● To move the frame, press the
[ ][ ][ ][ ] buttons.
Cropping
 Still Images Before Use
 Movies
You can specify a portion of an image to save as a separate image file.
1 Choose [Cropping].
●● Press the [
] button, and then
choose [Cropping] on the [
] tab
(= 30).
2 Choose an image.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose an
image, and then press the [ ] button.
●● Faces detected in the image are
enclosed in gray frames in the upper-left
image.
To crop the image based on this frame,
] dial to switch to the other
turn the [
frame.
●● Press the [
] button.
4 Save as a new image and review.
●● Follow steps 4 – 5 in “Resizing Images”
(= 116).
●● Editing is not possible for images shot at a resolution of [ ]
(= 52) or resized to [ ] (= 116).
●● RAW images cannot be edited.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● Images supported for cropping will have the same aspect ratio
after cropping.
●● Cropped images will have a lower resolution than uncropped
images.
●● If you crop still images shot using Face ID (= 47), only the
names of the people left in the cropped image will remain.
117
Changing Image Color Tones (My Colors)
 Still Images  Movies
You can adjust image colors and then save the edited image as a
separate file. For details on each option, see “Changing Image Color
Tones (My Colors)” (= 77).
1
Before Use
Correcting Image Brightness (i-Contrast)
Choose [My Colors].
●● Press the [
] button, and then
choose [My Colors] on the [
] tab
(= 30).
2 Choose an image.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose an
image, and then press the [ ] button.
3 Choose an option.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose an
option, and then press the [ ] button.
4 Save as a new image and review.
●● Follow steps 4 – 5 in “Resizing Images”
(= 116).
●● Image quality of pictures you repeatedly edit this way will be
a little lower each time, and you may not be able to obtain the
desired color.
●● Colors of RAW images cannot be edited.
 Still Images  Movies
Excessively dark image areas (such as faces or backgrounds) can be
detected and automatically adjusted to the optimal brightness. Insufficient
overall image contrast is also automatically corrected, to make subjects
stand out better. Choose from four correction levels, and then save the
image as a separate file.
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
1 Choose [i-Contrast].
●● Press the [
] button, and then
choose [i-Contrast] on the [
] tab
(= 30).
2 Choose an image.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose an
image, and then press the [ ] button.
3 Choose an option.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose an
option, and then press the [ ] button.
4 Save as a new image and review.
●● Follow steps 4 – 5 in “Resizing Images”
(= 116).
●● For some images, correction may be inaccurate or may cause
images to appear grainy.
●● Images may look grainy after repeated editing using this function.
●● RAW images cannot be edited this way.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● The color of images edited using this function may vary slightly
from the color of images shot using My Colors (= 77).
●● If [Auto] does not produce the expected results, try correcting
images using [Low], [Medium], or [High].
118
Correcting Red-Eye
 Still Images  Movies
Automatically corrects images affected by red-eye. You can save the
corrected image as a separate file.
1 Choose [Red-Eye Correction].
●● Press the [
] button, and then
choose [Red-Eye Correction] on the [
tab (= 30).
●● Some images may not be corrected accurately.
●● To overwrite the original image with the corrected image, choose
[Overwrite] in step 4. In this case, the original image will be
erased.
●● Protected images cannot be overwritten.
●● RAW images cannot be edited this way.
●● Red-eye correction can be applied to JPEG images shot in [ ],
but the original image cannot be overwritten.
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
]
2 Choose an image.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose an
image.
3 Correct the image.
●● Press the [
] button.
●● Red-eye detected by the camera is now
corrected, and frames are displayed
around corrected image areas.
●● Enlarge or reduce images as needed.
Follow the steps in “Magnifying Images”
(= 108).
4 Save as a new image and review.
●● Press the [ ][ ][ ][ ] buttons to choose
[New File], and then press the [ ] button.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● The image is now saved as a new file.
●● Follow step 5 in “Resizing Images”
(= 116).
119
3 Review the edited movie.
Editing Movies
 Still Images  Movies
You can cut movies to remove unneeded portions at the beginning or end
(excluding digest movies (= 35)).
1 Choose [
].
●● Following steps 1 – 5 in “Viewing”
(= 101), choose [ ] and press the [
button.
●● The movie editing panel and editing bar
are now displayed.
(1)
2 Specify portions to cut.
●● (1) is the movie editing panel, and (2) is
the editing bar.
●● Press the [
or [ ].
(2)
][
] buttons to choose [
Basic Guide
●● To edit the movie again, repeat step 2.
Advanced Guide
]
●● To cancel editing, press the [
button, press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose
[OK], and then press the [ ] button.
4
]
]
●● To view the portions you can cut
(identified by [ ] on the screen), press
the [ ][ ] buttons to move [ ]. Cut the
beginning of the movie (from [ ]) by
choosing [ ], and cut the end of the
movie by choosing [ ].
●● If you move [ ] to a position other than a
[ ] mark, in [ ] the portion before the
nearest [ ] mark on the left will be cut,
while in [ ] the portion after the nearest
[ ] mark on the right will be cut.
Before Use
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose [ ],
and then press the [ ] button. The edited
movie is now played.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Save the edited movie.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose [ ],
and then press the [ ] button.
●● Press the [ ][ ][ ][ ] buttons to choose
[New File], and then press the [ ] button.
●● Choose [Save w/o Comp.], and then
press the [ ] button.
●● The movie is now saved as a new file.
●● To overwrite the original movie with the cut one, choose
[Overwrite] in step 4. In this case, the original movie will be
erased.
●● If the memory card lacks sufficient space, only [Overwrite] will be
available.
●● Movies may not be saved if the battery pack runs out while saving
is in progress.
●● When editing movies, you should use a fully charged battery pack
or an AC adapter kit (sold separately, = 155).
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
120
Reducing File Sizes
Before Use
Editing Digest Movies
 Still Images Movie file sizes can be reduced by compressing movies as follows.
●● On the screen in step 2 of “Editing
Movies”, choose [ ]. Choose [New File],
and then press the [ ] button.
●● Choose [Compress & Sav.], and then
press the [ ] button.
●● Compressed movies are saved in [
] format.
] movies cannot be compressed.
●● [
●● Edited movies cannot be saved in compressed format when you
choose [Overwrite].
 Movies
Individual chapters (clips) (= 35) recorded in [ ] mode can be
erased, as needed. Be careful when erasing clips, because they cannot
be recovered.
1
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Select the clip to erase.
●● Follow steps 1 – 2 in “Viewing Short
Movies Created When Shooting Still
Images (Digest Movies)” (= 104) to
play a movie created in [ ] mode, and
then press the [ ] button to access the
movie control panel.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose [
[ ], and then press the [ ] button.
2 Choose [
] or
].
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose [ ],
and then press the [ ] button.
●● The selected clip is played back
repeatedly.
3
Confirm erasure.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose [OK],
and then press the [ ] button.
●● The clip is erased, and the short movie is
overwritten.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● [ ] is not displayed if you select a clip when the camera is
connected to a printer.
121
7
Wi-Fi Functions
Send images wirelessly from the camera to a variety of compatible
devices, and use the camera with Web services
Available Wi-Fi Features
You can send and receive images and control the camera remotely by
connecting it to these devices and services via Wi-Fi.
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
●● Smartphones and Tablets
Send images to smartphones and tablet computers that have Wi-Fi
functions. You can also shoot remotely and geotag your shots from a
smartphone or tablet.
For convenience in this manual, smartphones, tablets, and other
compatible devices are collectively referred to as “smartphones”.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● Computer
Use software to save camera images to a computer connected via
Wi-Fi.
●● Web Services
Add your account information to the camera for CANON iMAGE
GATEWAY online photography service or other Web services to send
camera images to the services. Unsent images on the camera can
also be sent automatically to a computer or Web service via CANON
iMAGE GATEWAY.
●● Printers
Send images wirelessly to a PictBridge-compatible printer (supporting
DPS over IP) to print them.
●● Another Camera
Send images wirelessly between Wi-Fi compatible Canon cameras.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
122
Sending Images to a Smartphone
Connect the camera to a smartphone and send images in either of these
ways.
●● Connect to a device assigned to the [ ] button (= 123)
Simply press the [ ] button to connect the devices. This simplifies
importing images from a smartphone (= 123). Note that only one
smartphone can be assigned to the [ ] button.
●● Connect via the Wi-Fi menu (= 125)
You can connect the camera to a smartphone as you would connect it
to a computer or other device. Multiple smartphones can be added.
Before connecting to the camera, you must install the free dedicated
CameraWindow app on the smartphone. For details on this application
(supported smartphones and included functions), refer to the Canon
website.
●● No matter how you connect the devices, you can also use the
smartphone to geotag (= 141) camera images and shoot
remotely (= 142).
Sending to a Smartphone Assigned to the Button
Once you have connected to a smartphone initially by pressing the [ ]
button, you can simply press the [ ] button after that to connect again for
viewing and saving camera images on connected devices.
These steps show how to use the camera as an access point, but you can
also use an existing access point (= 126).
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
1 Install CameraWindow.
●● For an NFC-compatible Android
smartphone (OS version 4.0 or later),
activating NFC and touching the
smartphone against the camera’s
N-Mark ( ) will start Google Play on the
smartphone. Once the CameraWindow
download page is displayed, download
and install the app.
●● For other Android smartphones, find
CameraWindow in Google Play and
download and install the app.
●● For an iPhone, iPad, or iPod touch, find
CameraWindow in the App Store and
download and install the app.
2 Press the [
] button.
●● Press the [ ] button.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● When the [Device Nickname] screen is
displayed, press the [ ] button. Use the
keyboard displayed to enter a nickname
(= 31). On the [Device Nickname]
screen, press the [ ][ ] buttons to
choose [OK], and then press the [ ]
button.
123
3 Choose [
].
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose [ ],
and then press the [ ] button.
●● The camera’s SSID is displayed.
6 Choose a smartphone to connect to.
Before Use
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose the
smartphone, and then press the [ ]
button.
Basic Guide
●● After a connection is established with
the smartphone, the smartphone name
is displayed on the camera. (This screen
will close in about one minute.)
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
7 Import images.
●● Use the smartphone to import images
from the camera to the smartphone.
4 Connect the smartphone to the
network.
●● In the smartphone’s Wi-Fi setting menu,
choose the SSID (network name)
displayed on the camera to establish a
connection.
5 Start CameraWindow.
●● For an NFC-compatible Android
smartphone (OS version 4.0 or later),
activating NFC and touching the
smartphone against the camera’s N-Mark
( ) will start CameraWindow on the
smartphone.
●● Use the smartphone to end the
connection; the camera will automatically
turn off.
●● When using NFC, keep the following points in mind.
-- Avoid strong impact between the camera and smartphone. This
may damage the devices.
-- Depending on the smartphone, the devices may not recognize
each other immediately. In this case, try holding the devices
together in slightly different positions.
-- Do not place other objects between the camera and
smartphone. Also, note that camera or smartphone covers or
similar accessories may block communication.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● For other smartphones, start
CameraWindow on the smartphone.
●● After the camera recognizes the
smartphone, a device selection screen is
displayed.
124
●● Connections require that a memory card be in the camera.
●● A message is displayed if the nickname you enter begins with
a symbol or space. Press the [ ] button and enter a different
nickname.
●● For better security, you can require password input on the screen
in step 3 by accessing MENU (= 30) and choosing [ ] tab
► [Wi-Fi Settings] ► [Password] ► [On]. In this case, in the
password field on the smartphone in step 4, enter the password
displayed on the camera.
●● One smartphone can be registered to the [ ] button. To assign
a different one, first clear the current one in MENU (= 30) ►
[ ] tab ► [Mobile Device Connect Button].
●● Not all NFC-compatible smartphones have an N-Mark ( ). For
details, refer to the smartphone user manual.
3 Choose [
].
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose [ ],
and then press the [ ] button.
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
4 Choose [Add a Device].
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose [Add
a Device], and then press the [ ] button.
●● The camera’s SSID is displayed.
Adding a Smartphone Using the Wi-Fi Menu
These steps show how to use the camera as an access point, but you can
also use an existing access point (= 126).
1 Install CameraWindow.
●● Follow step 1 in “Sending to a
Smartphone Assigned to the Button”
(= 123) to install CameraWindow on a
smartphone.
2 Access the Wi-Fi menu.
●● Press the [
on.
●● Press the [
●● Choose a smartphone to connect to, as
described in steps 4 – 6 of “Sending to
a Smartphone Assigned to the Button”
(= 123).
5 Adjust the privacy setting.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose [Yes],
and then press the [ ] button.
●● You can now use the smartphone to
browse, import, or geotag images on the
camera or shoot remotely.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
] button to turn the camera
] button.
●● If a screen requesting the device
nickname is displayed, enter the
nickname (= 123).
125
6 Send images.
●● Press the [ ][ ][ ][ ] buttons to choose
[Select and send], and then press the [ ]
button.
●● Press the [ ][ ][ ][ ] buttons to choose
an image to send, press the [ ] button to
mark it as selected ([ ]), and then press
the [
] button.
●● Press the [ ][ ][ ][ ] buttons to choose
[Send], and then press the [ ] button.
●● Image transfer will begin. The screen
darkens during image transfer.
●● [Transfer completed] is displayed after
the image is sent, and the image transfer
screen is displayed again.
●● To cancel the connection, press the
] button, press the [ ][ ] buttons
[
on the confirmation screen to choose
[OK], and then press the [ ] button. You
can also use the smartphone to end the
connection.
●● To add multiple smartphones, repeat the
above procedures starting from step 1.
●● All images in the camera can be viewed from the connected
smartphone when you choose [Yes] in step 5. To keep camera
images private, so that they cannot be viewed from the
smartphone, choose [No] in step 5.
●● Once you have registered a smartphone, you can change privacy
settings for it on the camera (= 143).
●● Connections require that a memory card be in the camera.
●● Once you have connected to devices via the Wi-Fi menu, recent
destinations will be listed first when you access the Wi-Fi menu.
You can easily connect again by pressing the [ ][ ] buttons to
choose the device and then pressing the [ ] button. To add a
new device, display the device selection screen by pressing the
[ ][ ] buttons, and then configure the setting.
●● If you prefer not to display recent target devices, choose MENU
(= 30) ► [ ] tab ► [Wi-Fi Settings] ► [Target History] ► [Off].
●● You can also send multiple images at once and change the image
size before sending (= 138).
●● You can send the current image by choosing [Send this image] on
the screen in step 6.
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Using Another Access Point
When connecting the camera to a smartphone with the [ ] button or
through the Wi-Fi menu, you can also use an existing access point.
1 Prepare for the connection.
●● Access the [Waiting to connect] screen.
Either follow steps 1 – 3 in “Sending to
a Smartphone Assigned to the Button”
(= 123) or steps 1 – 4 in “Adding a
Smartphone Using the Wi-Fi Menu”
(= 125).
2 Connect the smartphone to the
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
access point.
126
3 Choose [Switch Network].
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose
[Switch Network], and then press the [
button.
●● A list of detected access points will be
displayed.
]
4 Connect to the access point and
choose the smartphone.
●● For WPS-compatible access points,
connect to the access point and choose
the smartphone as described in steps
5 – 8 in “Using WPS-Compatible Access
Points” (= 130).
●● For non-WPS access points, follow steps
2 – 4 in “Connecting to Listed Access
Points” (= 132) to connect to the
access point and choose the smartphone.
5 Configure the privacy settings and
send images.
●● Follow steps 5 – 6 in “Adding a
Smartphone Using the Wi-Fi Menu”
(= 125) to configure the privacy
settings and send images.
Saving Images to a Computer
Preparing to Register a Computer
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Checking Your Computer Environment
The camera can connect via Wi-Fi to computers running the following
operating systems. For detailed system requirements and compatibility
information, including support in new operating systems, visit the Canon
website.
●● Windows 8/8.1
●● Windows 7 SP1
●● Mac OS X 10.9
●● Mac OS X 10.8.2 or later
●● Windows 7 Starter and Home Basic editions are not supported.
●● Windows 7 N (European version) and KN (South Korean version)
require a separate download and installation of Windows Media
Feature Pack.
For details, check the following website.
http://go.microsoft.com/fwlink/?LinkId=159730
Previous Access Points
To reconnect to a previous access point automatically, follow step 3 in
“Sending to a Smartphone Assigned to the Button” (= 123) or step 4 in
“Adding a Smartphone Using the Wi-Fi Menu” (= 125).
●● To use the camera as an access point, choose [Switch Network] on the
screen displayed when you establish a connection, and then choose
[Camera Access Point Mode].
●● To reconnect to a previous access point, follow the procedure from
step 5 in “Using Another Access Point” (= 126).
●● To switch access points, choose [Switch Network] on the screen
displayed when you establish a connection, and then follow the
procedure in “Using Another Access Point” (= 126) from step 4.
Installing the Software
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
Windows 7 and Mac OS X 10.8 are used here for the sake of illustration.
What you will need:
●● Computer
●● USB cable (camera end: Mini-B)*
* A USB cable is not included. Although you can install the software without using a
cable, some features will not be added.
127
1 Download the software.
●● With a computer connected to the Internet,
access http://www.canon.com/icpd/.
●● Access the site for your country or region.
●● Download the software.
2 Begin the installation.
●● Click [Easy Installation] and follow the
on-screen instructions to complete the
installation process.
3 When a message is displayed
prompting you to connect the camera,
choose whether to connect or not.
Without Connecting the Camera
●● Select [Install without connecting
the device] and follow the on-screen
instructions to complete the installation
process.
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
4 Install the files.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● Installation may take some time,
depending on computer performance and
the Internet connection.
●● Click [Finish] or [Restart] on the screen
after installation.
●● After installation when the camera is
connected to the computer, turn the
camera off before disconnecting the
cable.
●● Because the content and functions of software vary according to
the camera model, if you have several cameras, you must use
each camera to update to its latest version of the software.
When Connecting the Camera to the
Computer
(2)
(1)
●● With the camera turned off, open the
cover (1). With the smaller plug of the
USB cable in the orientation shown,
insert the plug fully into the camera
terminal (2).
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● Insert the larger plug of the USB cable
in the computer’s USB port. For details
about USB connections on the computer,
refer to the computer user manual.
●● Turn the camera on, and follow the
on-screen instructions to complete the
installation process.
128
Configuring the Computer for a Wi-Fi Connection
(Windows Only)
On a computer running Windows, configure the following settings before
connecting the camera to the computer wirelessly.
1 Confirm that the computer is
connected to an access point.
●● For instructions on checking your network
connection, refer to the computer user
manual.
2 Configure the setting.
●● Click in the following order: [Start] menu
► [All Programs] ► [Canon Utilities] ►
[CameraWindow] ► [Wi-Fi connection
setup].
●● In the application that opens, follow the
on-screen instructions and configure the
setting.
●● The following Windows settings are configured when you run the
utility in step 2.
-- Turn on media streaming.
This will enable the camera to see (find) the computer to access
via Wi-Fi.
-- Turn on network discovery.
This will enable the computer to see (find) the camera.
-- Turn on ICMP (Internet Control Message Protocol).
This allows you to check the network connection status.
-- Enable Universal Plug & Play (UPnP).
This will enable network devices to detect each other
automatically.
●● Some security software may prevent you from completing the
settings as described here. Check the settings of your security
software.
Saving Images to a Connected Computer
Connect to your access point via Wi-Fi as follows.
Also refer to the access point user manual.
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
Confirming Access Point Compatibility
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Confirm that the Wi-Fi router or base station conforms to the Wi-Fi
standards in “Wi-Fi” (= 196).
Connection methods vary depending on whether the access point
supports Wi-Fi Protected Setup (WPS, = 130) or not (= 132). For
non-WPS access points, check the following information.
●● Network name (SSID/ESSID)
The SSID or ESSID for the access point you use. Also called the
“access point name” or “network name”.
●● Network authentication / data encryption (encryption method /
encryption mode)
The method for encrypting data during wireless transmission. Check
which security setting is used: WPA2-PSK (AES), WPA2-PSK
(TKIP), WPA-PSK (AES), WPA-PSK (TKIP), WEP (open system
authentication), or no security.
●● Password (encryption key / network key)
The key used when encrypting data during wireless transmission. Also
called the “encryption key” or “network key”.
●● Key index (transmit key)
The key set when WEP is used for network authentication / data
encryption. Use “1” as the setting.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● If system administrator status is needed to adjust network
settings, contact the system administrator for details.
●● These settings are very important for network security. Exercise
adequate caution when changing these settings.
129
●● For information on WPS compatibility and for instructions on
checking settings, refer to the access point user manual.
●● A router is a device that creates a network (LAN) structure for
connecting multiple computers. A router that contains an internal
Wi-Fi function is called a “Wi-Fi router”.
●● This guide refers to all Wi-Fi routers and base stations as “access
points”.
●● If you use MAC address filtering on your Wi-Fi network, be sure
to add the camera’s MAC address to your access point. You can
check your camera’s MAC address by choosing MENU (= 30)
► [ ] tab ► [Wi-Fi Settings] ► [Check MAC Address].
3 Choose [
].
●● Press the [ ][ ][ ][ ] buttons to choose
[ ], and then press the [ ] button.
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
4 Choose [Add a Device].
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose [Add
a Device], and then press the [ ] button.
Using WPS-Compatible Access Points
WPS makes it easy to complete settings when connecting devices over
Wi-Fi. You can use either Push Button Configuration Method or PIN
Method for settings on a WPS supported device.
1
Confirm that the computer is
connected to an access point.
●● For instructions on checking the
connection, refer to the device and
access point user manuals.
2 Access the Wi-Fi menu.
●● Press the [
on.
●● Press the [
] button to turn the camera
5 Choose [WPS Connection].
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose
[WPS Connection], and then press the
[ ] button.
6 Choose [PBC Method].
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose [PBC
Method], and then press the [ ] button.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
] button.
●● When the [Device Nickname] screen is
displayed, press the [ ] button. Use the
keyboard displayed to enter a nickname
(= 31). On the [Device Nickname]
screen, press the [ ][ ] buttons to
choose [OK], and then press the [ ]
button.
130
7 Establish the connection.
●● On the access point, hold down the WPS
connection button for a few seconds.
●● On the camera, press the [
go to the next step.
] button to
●● The camera connects to the access point
and lists devices connected to it on the
[Select a Device] screen.
8
Choose the target device.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose the
target device name, and then press the
[ ] button.
9 Install a driver (first Windows
10 Display CameraWindow.
●● Windows: Access CameraWindow by
clicking [Downloads Images From Canon
Camera].
●● Mac OS: CameraWindow is automatically
displayed when a Wi-Fi connection is
established between the camera and
computer.
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11 Import images.
●● Click [Import Images from Camera], and
then click [Import Untransferred Images].
●● Images are now saved to the Pictures
folder on the computer, in separate
folders named by date.
●● Click [OK] in the screen that is displayed
after image import is complete. For
instructions on viewing images on a
computer, refer to “Software Instruction
Manual” (= 164).
connection only).
●● When this screen is displayed on the
camera, click the Start menu on the
computer, click [Control Panel], and then
click [Add a device].
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● Double-click the connected camera icon.
●● Driver installation will begin.
●● After driver installation is complete, and
the camera and computer connection
is enabled, the AutoPlay screen will be
displayed. Nothing will be displayed on
the camera screen.
131
●● Once you have connected to devices via the Wi-Fi menu, recent
destinations will be listed first when you access the Wi-Fi menu.
You can easily connect again by pressing the [ ][ ] buttons to
choose the device and then pressing the [ ] button. To add a
new device, display the device selection screen by pressing the
[ ][ ] buttons, and then configure the setting.
●● If you prefer not to display recent target devices, choose MENU
(= 30) ► [ ] tab ► [Wi-Fi Settings] ► [Target History] ► [Off].
●● A message is displayed if the nickname you enter begins with
a symbol or space. Press the [ ] button and enter a different
nickname.
●● When the camera is connected to a computer, the camera screen
is blank.
●● Mac OS: If CameraWindow is not displayed, click the
[CameraWindow] icon in the Dock.
●● To disconnect from the camera, turn off the camera.
●● If you chose [PIN Method] in step 6, a PIN code will be displayed
on the screen. Be sure to set this code in the access point.
Choose a device in the [Select a Device] screen. For further
details, refer to the user manual included with your access point.
Connecting to Listed Access Points
1 View the listed access points.
●● View the listed networks (access points)
as described in steps 1 – 4 of “Using
WPS-Compatible Access Points”
(= 130).
2 Choose an access point.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose a
network (access point), and then press
the [ ] button.
3 Enter the access point password.
●● Press the [ ] button to access the
keyboard, and then enter the password
(= 31).
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose
[Next], and then press the [ ] button.
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
4 Choose [Auto].
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose
[Auto], and then press the [ ] button.
●● To save images to a connected computer,
follow the procedure from step 8 in “Using
WPS-Compatible Access Points” (= 130).
●● To determine the access point password, check on the access
point itself or refer to the user manual.
●● Up to 16 access points will be displayed. If no access points are
detected even after you choose [Refresh] in step 2 to update the
list, choose [Manual Settings] in step 2 to complete access point
settings manually. Follow on-screen instructions and enter an
SSID, security settings, and a password.
●● When you use an access point that you have already connected
to for connecting to another device, [*] is displayed for the
password in step 3. To use the same password, press the [ ][ ]
buttons to choose [Next], and then press the [ ] button.
Previous Access Points
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
You can reconnect to any previous access points automatically by
following step 4 in “Using WPS-Compatible Access Points” (= 130).
●● To reconnect to the access point, confirm that the target device is
already connected to it, and then follow the procedure from step 8 in
“Using WPS-Compatible Access Points” (= 130).
●● To switch access points, choose [Switch Network] on the screen
displayed after connection, and then either follow the procedure in
“Using WPS-Compatible Access Points” (= 130) from step 5 or the
procedure in “Connecting to Listed Access Points” (= 132) from step 2.
132
Sending Images to a Registered
Web Service
Registering Web Services
Use a smartphone or computer to add to the camera Web services that
you want to use.
●● A smartphone or computer with a browser and Internet connection is
required to complete camera settings for CANON iMAGE GATEWAY
and other Web services.
●● Check the CANON iMAGE GATEWAY website for details on browser
(Microsoft Internet Explorer, etc.) requirements, including settings and
version information.
●● For information on countries and regions where CANON iMAGE
GATEWAY is available, visit the Canon website (http://www.canon.
com/cig/).
●● You must have an account with Web services other than CANON
iMAGE GATEWAY if you desire to use them. For further details, check
the websites for each Web service you want to register.
●● Separate ISP connection and access point fees may be applicable.
Registering CANON iMAGE GATEWAY
Before Use
After linking the camera and CANON iMAGE GATEWAY, add CANON
iMAGE GATEWAY as a destination Web service on the camera.
1 Log in to CANON iMAGE GATEWAY
and access the camera web link
settings page.
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● From a computer or smartphone, access
http://www.canon.com/cig/ to visit CANON
iMAGE GATEWAY.
●● Once the login screen is displayed,
enter your user name and password
to log in. If you do not have a CANON
iMAGE GATEWAY account, follow
the instructions to complete member
registration (free of charge).
2 Choose the type of camera.
●● On this camera model, [
in the Wi-Fi menu.
] is displayed
], a page is
●● Once you choose [
displayed for entering the authentication
code. On this page in step 7, you will
enter the authentication code displayed
on the camera after steps 3 – 6.
3
Access the Wi-Fi menu.
●● Press the [
] button to turn the camera on.
●● Press the [
] button.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● When the [Device Nickname] screen is
displayed, press the [ ] button. Use the
keyboard displayed to enter a nickname
(= 31). On the [Device Nickname]
screen, press the [ ][ ] buttons to
choose [OK], and then press the [ ]
button.
133
4 Choose [
8 Check the confirmation numbers
].
●● Press the [ ][ ][ ][ ] buttons to choose
[
], and then press the [ ] button.
●● Make sure the confirmation number on
the camera matches the number on the
smartphone or computer.
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose [OK],
and then press the [ ] button.
5 Choose [Authenticate].
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose
[Authenticate], and then press the [
button.
and complete the setup process.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● Complete the setup process on the
smartphone or computer.
]
6 Establish a connection with an
access point.
●● Connect to the access point as described
in steps 5 – 7 in “Using WPS-Compatible
Access Points” (= 130) or in steps 2 – 4
in “Connecting to Listed Access Points”
(= 132).
●● Once the camera is connected to CANON
iMAGE GATEWAY via the access point,
an authentication code is displayed.
●● [ ] (= 139) and CANON iMAGE
GATEWAY are now added as
destinations, and the [
] icon changes
to [
].
●● A message is displayed on the
smartphone or computer to indicate that
this process is finished. To add other
Web services, follow the procedure
in “Registering Other Web Services”
(= 135) from step 2.
●● Connections require that a memory card with saved images be in
the camera.
●● Once you have connected to devices via the Wi-Fi menu, recent
destinations will be listed first when you access the menu. Press
the [ ][ ] buttons to access the device selection screen and
choose a device.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
7 Enter the authentication code.
●● On the smartphone or computer, enter
the authentication code displayed on the
camera and go to the next step.
●● A six-digit confirmation number is
displayed.
134
Registering Other Web Services
You can also add Web services besides CANON iMAGE GATEWAY to the
camera. Note that CANON iMAGE GATEWAY must be registered on the
camera first (= 133).
1 Access the Web service settings
screen.
●● Follow step 1 in “Registering CANON
iMAGE GATEWAY” (= 133) to log in
to CANON iMAGE GATEWAY, and then
access the Web service settings screen.
2 Configure the Web service you want
to use.
●● Follow the instructions displayed on the
smartphone or computer to set up the
Web service.
3
Choose [
].
●● In Playback mode, press the [
to access the Wi-Fi menu.
] button
●● Press the [ ][ ][ ][ ] buttons to choose
[
], and then press the [ ] button.
●● The Web service settings are now
updated.
●● If any configured settings change, follow these steps again to
update the camera settings.
Uploading Images to Web Services
Before Use
Basic Guide
1 Access the Wi-Fi menu.
●● Press the [
] button to turn the camera on.
●● Press the [
] button.
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
2 Choose the destination.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose the
icon of the Web service for sharing, and
then press the [ ] button.
●● If multiple recipients or sharing options
are used with a Web service, choose the
desired item on the [Select Recipient]
screen by pressing the [ ][ ] buttons,
and then press the [ ] button.
3 Send images.
●● Press the [ ][ ][ ][ ] buttons to choose
[Select and send], and then press the [ ]
button.
●● Press the [ ][ ][ ][ ] buttons to choose
an image to send, press the [ ] button to
mark it as selected ([ ]), and then press
the [
] button.
●● Press the [ ][ ][ ][ ] buttons to choose
[Send], and then press the [ ] button.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● When uploading to YouTube, read the
terms of service, choose [I Agree], and
press the [ ] button.
●● Image transfer will begin. The screen
darkens during image transfer.
●● After the images are sent, [OK] is
displayed. Press the [ ] button to return
to the playback screen.
135
●● Connections require that a memory card with saved images be in
the camera.
●● You can also send multiple images at once and resize images or
add comments before sending (= 138).
●● You can send the current image by choosing [Send this image] on
the screen in step 3.
Printing Images Wirelessly from a
Connected Printer
Connect the camera to a printer via Wi-Fi to print as follows.
These steps show how to use the camera as an access point, but you can
also use an existing access point (= 136).
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
1 Access the Wi-Fi menu.
●● Access the Wi-Fi menu as described in
step 2 in “Adding a Smartphone Using
the Wi-Fi Menu” (= 125).
2 Choose [
].
●● Press the [ ][ ][ ][ ] buttons to choose
[ ], and then press the [ ] button.
3 Choose [Add a Device].
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose [Add
a Device], and then press the [ ] button.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● The camera’s SSID is displayed.
136
4 Connect the printer to the network.
●● In the printer’s Wi-Fi setting menu,
choose the SSID (network name)
displayed on the camera to establish a
connection.
5 Choose the printer.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose the
printer name, and then press the [ ]
button.
Sending Images to Another Camera
Connect two cameras via Wi-Fi and send images between them as
follows.
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
●● Only Canon-brand cameras equipped with a Wi-Fi function can be
connected to wirelessly. Even Canon-brand cameras that support EyeFi cards cannot be connected to if they do not have a Wi-Fi function.
You cannot connect to PowerShot SD430 DIGITAL ELPH WIRELESS/
DIGITAL IXUS WIRELESS cameras with this camera.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
1 Access the Wi-Fi menu.
6 Choose an image to print.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose an
image.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose
[Print], and then press the [ ] button.
●● Access the Wi-Fi menu as described in
step 2 in “Adding a Smartphone Using
the Wi-Fi Menu” (= 125).
2 Choose [
].
●● Press the [ ][ ][ ][ ] buttons to choose
[ ], and then press the [ ] button.
●● For detailed printing instructions, see
“Printing Images” (= 166).
●● To cancel the connection, press the [ ]
button, press the [ ][ ] buttons on the
confirmation screen to choose [OK], and
then press the [ ] button.
●● Connections require that a memory card with saved images be in
the camera.
●● Once you have connected to devices via the Wi-Fi menu, recent
destinations will be listed first when you access the Wi-Fi menu.
You can easily connect again by pressing the [ ][ ] buttons to
choose the device and then pressing the [ ] button. To add a
new device, display the device selection screen by pressing the
[ ][ ] buttons, and then configure the setting.
●● If you prefer not to display recent target devices, choose MENU
(= 30) ► [ ] tab ► [Wi-Fi Settings] ► [Target History] ► [Off].
●● To use another access point, follow steps 3 – 4 in “Using Another
Access Point” (= 126).
3 Choose [Add a Device].
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose [Add
a Device], and then press the [ ] button.
●● Follow steps 1 – 3 on the target camera
too.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● Camera connection information will be
added when [Start connection on target
camera] is displayed on both camera
screens.
137
4 Send images.
●● Press the [ ][ ][ ][ ] buttons to choose
[Select and send], and then press the [ ]
button.
●● Press the [ ][ ][ ][ ] buttons to choose
an image to send, press the [ ] button to
mark it as selected ([ ]), and then press
the [
] button.
●● Press the [ ][ ][ ][ ] buttons to choose
[Send], and then press the [ ] button.
Image Sending Options
You can choose multiple images to send at once and change the image
resolution (size) before sending. Some Web services also enable you to
annotate the images you send.
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Notes on Sending Images
●● Image transfer will begin. The screen
darkens during image transfer.
●● Keep your fingers or other objects off the Wi-Fi antenna area
(= 3). Covering this may decrease the speed of your image
transfers.
●● [Transfer completed] is displayed after
the image is sent, and the image transfer
screen is displayed again.
●● Depending on the condition of the network you are using, it may take
a long time to send movies. Be sure to keep an eye on the camera
battery level.
●● To cancel the connection, press the
] button, press the [ ][ ] buttons
[
on the confirmation screen to choose
[OK], and then press the [ ] button.
●● Up to 50 images can be sent together at once. One movie up to five
minutes (or one digest movie up to 13 minutes) can be sent. However,
Web services may limit the number of images or length of movies you
can send. For details, refer to the Web service you are using.
●● Connections require that a memory card be in the camera.
●● Once you have connected to devices via the Wi-Fi menu, recent
destinations will be listed first when you access the Wi-Fi menu.
You can easily connect again by pressing the [ ][ ] buttons to
choose the device and then pressing the [ ] button. To add a
new device, display the device selection screen by pressing the
[ ][ ] buttons, and then configure the setting.
●● If you prefer not to display recent target devices, choose MENU
(= 30) ► [ ] tab ► [Wi-Fi Settings] ► [Target History] ►
[Off].
●● You can also send multiple images at once and change the image
size before sending (= 138).
●● You can send the current image by choosing [Send this image] on
the screen in step 4.
Before Use
●● For movies that you do not compress (= 121), a separate,
compressed file is sent instead of the original file. Note that this may
delay transmission, and the file cannot be sent unless there is enough
space for it on the memory card.
●● When sending movies to smartphones, note that the supported image
quality varies depending on the smartphone. For details, refer to the
smartphone user manual.
●● On the screen, wireless signal strength is indicated by the following
icons.
[ ] high, [ ] medium, [ ] low, [ ] weak
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● Sending images to Web services will take less time when resending
images you have already sent that are still on the CANON iMAGE
GATEWAY server.
138
Choosing the Image Resolution (Size)
On the image transfer screen, choose [ ] by pressing the [ ][ ]
buttons, and then press the [ ] button. On the screen displayed, choose
the resolution by pressing the [ ][ ] buttons, and then press the [ ]
button.
●● To send images at original size, select [No] as the resizing option.
●● Choosing [ ] or [ ] will resize images that are larger than the
selected size before sending.
●● Movies cannot be resized.
●● Image size can also be configured in MENU (= 30) ► [
► [Wi-Fi Settings] ► [Resize for Sending].
] tab
Sending Images Automatically
(Image Sync)
Images on the memory card that have not been transferred already can
be sent to a computer or Web services via CANON iMAGE GATEWAY.
Note that images cannot be sent only to Web services.
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Initial Preparations
Preparing the Camera
Register [ ] as the destination. You can also assign [ ] to the [ ] button,
so that you can simply press the [ ] button to send any unsent images on
the memory card to a computer via CANON iMAGE GATEWAY.
Adding Comments
Using the camera, you can add comments to images that you send
to e-mail addresses, social networking services, etc. The number of
characters and symbols that can be entered may differ depending on the
Web service.
1 Access the screen for adding
comments.
●● On the image transfer screen, choose
[ ] by pressing the [ ][ ][ ][ ] buttons,
and then press the [ ] button.
2 Add a comment (= 31).
3 Send the image.
●● When a comment is not entered, the comment set in CANON
iMAGE GATEWAY is automatically sent.
●● You can also annotate multiple images before sending them. The
same comment is added to all images sent together.
1 Add [
] as a destination.
●● Add [ ] as a destination, as described in
“Registering CANON iMAGE GATEWAY”
(= 133).
●● To choose a Web service as the
destination, follow the steps in
“Registering Other Web Services”
(= 135) to update the camera settings.
2 Choose the type of images to send
(only when sending movies with
images).
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● Press the [
] button and choose
[Wi-Fi Settings] on the [ ] tab (= 30).
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose
[Image Sync], and then press the [ ][ ]
buttons to choose [Stills/Movies].
139
3 Assign [
] to the [ ] button (only
when sending images by pressing
the [ ] button).
●● Clear the [ ] button setting if a
smartphone is already assigned to the
button (= 123).
●● Access the mobile connection screen
as described in step 2 in “Sending to
a Smartphone Assigned to the Button”
(= 123), press the [ ][ ] buttons to
choose [ ], and then press the [ ]
button.
Images sent from the camera are automatically saved to the computer.
If the computer that you intend to send images to is turned off, the images
will be stored temporarily on the CANON iMAGE GATEWAY server.
Stored images are regularly erased, so make sure to turn on the computer
and save the images.
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● If you have already assigned [ ] to the
[ ] button, press the [ ] button.
●● If you have not assigned the button this
way, choose [ ] as described in steps
1 – 2 in “Uploading Images to Web
Services” (= 135).
Install and configure the software on the destination computer.
1 Install the software.
●● Once the connection is established,
the images are sent. When the images
have been sent successfully to the
CANON iMAGE GATEWAY server, [ ] is
displayed on the screen.
●● Install the software on a computer
connected to the Internet (= 127).
2 Register the camera.
],
2 Save the images to the computer.
], and
●● Images are automatically saved to the
computer when you turn it on.
●● Windows: In the taskbar, right-click [
and then click [Add new camera].
Basic Guide
1 Send images.
Preparing the Computer
●● Mac OS: In the menu bar, click [
then click [Add new camera].
Before Use
Sending Images
●● A list of cameras linked to CANON
iMAGE GATEWAY is displayed. Choose
the camera from which images are to be
sent.
●● Once the camera is registered and the
computer is ready to receive images, the
icon changes to [ ].
●● Images are automatically sent to Web
services from the CANON iMAGE
GATEWAY server, even if the computer
is off.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● When sending images, you should use a fully charged battery
pack or an AC adapter kit (sold separately, = 155).
140
●● Even if images were imported to the computer through a different
method, any images not sent to the computer via CANON iMAGE
GATEWAY will be sent to the computer.
●● Sending is faster when the destination is a computer on the same
network as the camera, because images are sent via the access
point instead of CANON iMAGE GATEWAY. Note that images
stored on the computer are sent to CANON iMAGE GATEWAY, so
the computer must be connected to the Internet.
Using a Smartphone to View Camera
Images and Control the Camera
You can do the following with the dedicated smartphone app
CameraWindow.
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● Browse images on the camera and save them to the smartphone
●● Geotag images on the camera (= 141)
●● Shoot remotely (= 142)
●● In camera settings, the smartphone must be allowed to view
camera images (= 123, = 125, = 143).
Geotagging Images on the Camera
GPS data recorded on a smartphone using the dedicated CameraWindow
application can be added to images on the camera. Images are tagged
with information including the latitude, longitude, and elevation.
●● Before shooting, make sure the date and time and your home
time zone are set correctly, as described in “Setting the Date and
Time” (= 20). Also follow the steps in “World Clock” (= 146)
to specify any shooting destinations in other time zones.
●● Others may be able to locate or identify you by using location data
in your geotagged still images or movies. Be careful when sharing
these images with others, as when posting images online where
many others can view them.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
141
Shooting Remotely
As you check a shooting screen on your smartphone, you can use it to
shoot remotely.
1
●● The camera works in [ ] mode during remote shooting. However,
some FUNC. and MENU settings you have configured in advance
may be changed automatically.
●● Movie shooting is not available.
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
Secure the camera.
●● Once remote shooting begins, the
camera lens will come out. Lens motion
from zooming may also move the camera
out of position. Keep the camera still by
mounting it on a tripod or taking other
measures.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● Any jerky subject motion shown on the smartphone due to the
connection environment will not affect recorded images.
●● No AF frames are displayed. Capture a test image to check the
focus.
●● Captured images are not transferred to the smartphone. Use the
smartphone to browse and import images from the camera.
2 Connect the camera and
smartphone (= 123, = 125).
●● In the privacy settings, choose [Yes].
3 Choose remote shooting.
●● In CameraWindow on the smartphone,
choose remote shooting.
●● The camera lens will come out. Do not
press near the lens, and make sure no
objects will obstruct it.
●● Once the camera is ready for remote
shooting, a live image from the camera
will be displayed on the smartphone.
●● At this time, a message is displayed on
the camera, and all operations except
pressing the power button are disabled.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
4 Shoot.
●● Use the smartphone to shoot.
142
Editing or Erasing Wi-Fi Settings
Configurable Items
Web
Services
Edit or erase Wi-Fi settings as follows.
Editing Connection Information
1 Access the Wi-Fi menu and choose
the device to edit.
●● Press the [ ] button to turn the camera on.
●● Press the [ ] button.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to access
the device selection screen, press the
[ ][ ][ ][ ] buttons to choose the icon
of a device to edit, and then press the
[ ] button.
2 Choose [Edit a Device].
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose [Edit
a Device], and then press the [ ] button.
Before Use
Connection
[Change Device Nickname] (= 143)
O
O
O
O
–
[View Settings] (= 125)
–
O
–
–
–
[Erase Connection Info] (= 143)
O
O
O
O
–
O : Configurable
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
– : Not configurable
Changing a Device Nickname
You can change the device nickname (display name) that is displayed on
the camera.
●● Following step 4 in “Editing Connection
Information” (= 143), choose [Change
Device Nickname] and press the [ ]
button.
●● Select the input field and press the [ ]
button. Use the keyboard displayed to
enter a new nickname (= 31).
Erasing Connection Information
3
Choose a device to edit.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose the
device to edit, and then press the [ ]
button.
4 Choose an item to edit.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose
an item to edit, and then press the [ ]
button.
●● The items you can change depend on
what device or service the camera will
access.
Erase connection information (information about devices that you have
connected to) as follows.
●● Following step 4 in “Editing Connection
Information” (= 143), choose [Erase
Connection Info] and press the [ ]
button.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● After [Erase?] is displayed, press the
[ ][ ] buttons to choose [OK], and then
press the [ ] button.
●● The connection information will be
erased.
143
Before Use
Returning the Wi-Fi Settings to Default
Basic Guide
Return the Wi-Fi settings to default if you transfer ownership of the
camera to another person, or dispose of it.
Resetting the Wi-Fi settings will also clear all Web service settings. Be
sure that you want to reset all Wi-Fi settings before using this option.
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
1 Choose [Wi-Fi Settings].
●● Press the [
] button and choose
[Wi-Fi Settings] on the [ ] tab (= 30).
2 Choose [Reset Settings].
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose
[Reset Settings], and then press the [
button.
]
3 Restore the default settings.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose [OK],
and then press the [ ] button.
●● The Wi-Fi settings are now reset.
●● To reset other settings (aside from Wi-Fi) to defaults, choose
[Reset All] on the [ ] tab (= 152).
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
144
8
Setting Menu
Customize or adjust basic camera functions for greater convenience
Before Use
Adjusting Basic Camera Functions
Basic Guide
MENU (= 30) functions on the [ ] tab can be configured. Customize
commonly used functions as desired, for greater convenience.
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Silencing Camera Operations
Silence camera sounds and movies as follows.
●● Choose [Mute], and then choose [On].
●● Operation can also be silenced by holding down the [ ] button
as you turn the camera on.
●● Sound is not played during movies (= 101) if you mute camera
sounds. To restore sound during movies, press the [ ] button.
Adjust volume with the [ ][ ] buttons, as needed.
Adjusting the Volume
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
Adjust the volume of individual camera sounds as follows.
●● Choose [Volume], and then press the [
button.
]
●● Choose an item, and then press the
[ ][ ] buttons to adjust the volume.
145
Before Use
Hiding Hints and Tips
World Clock
Hints and tips are normally shown when you choose FUNC. (= 29) or
MENU (= 30) items. If you prefer, you can deactivate this information.
To ensure that your shots will have the correct local date and time when
you travel abroad, simply register the destination in advance and switch to
that time zone. This convenient feature eliminates the need to change the
Date/Time setting manually.
Before using the world clock, be sure to set the date and time and your
home time zone, as described in “Setting the Date and Time” (= 20).
●● Choose [Hints & Tips], and then choose
[Off].
1
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Specify your destination.
●● Choose [Time Zone], and then press the
[ ] button.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose
[ World], and then press the [ ] button.
Date and Time
Adjust the date and time as follows.
●● Choose [Date/Time], and then press the
[ ] button.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose an
option, and then press the [ ][ ] buttons
to adjust the setting.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose the
destination.
●● To set daylight saving time (1 hour
ahead), choose [ ] by pressing the
[ ][ ] buttons, and then choose [ ] by
pressing the [ ][ ] buttons.
●● Press the [
] button.
2 Switch to the destination time zone.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose
[ World], and then press the [
button.
]
●● [ ] is now shown on the shooting screen
(= 180).
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● Adjusting the date or time while in [ ] mode (= 21) will
automatically update your [ Home] time and date.
146
Lens Retraction Timing
Power-Saving Adjustment
The lens is normally retracted for safety about one minute after you press
the [
] button in Shooting mode (= 25). To have the lens retracted
immediately after you press the [
] button, set the retraction timing to
[0 sec.].
Adjust the timing of automatic camera and screen deactivation (Auto
Power Down and Display Off, respectively) as needed (= 26).
●● Choose [Lens Retraction], and then
choose [0 sec.].
●● Choose [Power Saving], and then press
the [ ] button.
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● After choosing an item, press the [ ][ ]
buttons to adjust it as needed.
●● To conserve battery power, you should normally choose [On] for
[Auto Power Down] and [1 min.] or less for [Display Off].
Using Eco Mode
This function allows you to conserve battery power in Shooting mode.
When the camera is not in use, the screen quickly darkens to reduce
battery consumption.
1 Configure the setting.
●● The [Display Off] setting is applied even if you set [Auto Power
Down] to [Off].
●● These power-saving functions are not available when you have
set Eco mode (= 147) to [On].
●● Choose [Eco Mode], and then choose [On].
●● [
] is now shown on the shooting
screen (= 180).
●● The screen darkens when the camera
is not used for approximately two
seconds; approximately ten seconds
after darkening, the screen turns off.
The camera turns off after approximately
three minutes of inactivity.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
2 Shoot.
●● To activate the screen and prepare for
shooting when the screen is off but the
lens is still out, press the shutter button
halfway.
147
Before Use
Screen Brightness
Formatting Memory Cards
Adjust screen brightness as follows.
Screen and viewfinder brightness can be set separately. Activate the
desired display in advance by pressing the [
] button.
Before using a new memory card or a card formatted in another device, you
should format the card with this camera.
Formatting erases all data on a memory card. Before formatting, copy images
on the memory card to a computer, or take other steps to back them up.
●● Choose [LCD Brightness], and then
press the [ ][ ] buttons to adjust the
brightness.
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
1 Access the [Format] screen.
●● Choose [Format], and then press the [
button.
]
2 Choose [OK].
●● For maximum brightness, press and hold the [ ] button for at
least one second when the shooting screen is displayed or when
in single-image display. (This will override the [LCD Brightness]
setting on the [ ] tab.) To restore the original brightness, press
and hold the [ ] button again for at least one second or restart
the camera.
Hiding the Start-Up Screen
If you prefer, you can deactivate display of the start-up screen normally
shown when you turn the camera on.
●● Choose [Start-up Image], and then
choose [Off].
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose
[Cancel], press the [ ][ ] buttons to
choose [OK], and then press the [ ]
button.
3 Format the memory card.
●● To begin the formatting process, press
the [ ][ ] buttons to choose [OK], and
then press the [ ] button.
●● When formatting is finished, [Memory
card formatting complete] is displayed.
Press the [ ] button.
●● Formatting or erasing data on a memory card only changes file
management information on the card and does not erase the data
completely. When transferring or disposing of memory cards,
take steps to protect personal information if necessary, as by
physically destroying cards.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● The total card capacity indicated on the formatting screen may be
less than the advertised capacity.
148
Low-Level Formatting
Perform low-level formatting in the following cases: [Memory card error] is
displayed, the camera is not working correctly, card image reading/writing
is slower, continuous shooting is slower, or movie recording suddenly
stops. Low-level formatting erases all data on a memory card. Before lowlevel formatting, copy images on the memory card to a computer, or take
other steps to back them up.
Your shots are automatically numbered in sequential order (0001 – 9999)
and saved in folders that store up to 2,000 images each. You can change
how the camera assigns file numbers.
●● Low-level formatting takes longer than “Formatting Memory
Cards” (= 148), because data is erased from all storage regions
of the memory card.
●● You can cancel low-level formatting in progress by choosing
[Stop]. In this case, all data will be erased, but the memory card
can be used normally.
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● Choose [File Numbering], and then
choose an option.
●● On the screen in step 2 of “Formatting
Memory Cards” (= 148), press the
[ ][ ] buttons to choose [Low Level
Format], and then press the [ ][ ]
buttons to select this option. A [ ] icon is
displayed.
●● Follow steps 2 – 3 in “Formatting Memory
Cards” (= 148) to continue with the
formatting process.
Before Use
File Numbering
Continuous
Images are numbered consecutively (until the 9999th
shot is taken/saved) even if you switch memory
cards.
Auto Reset
Image numbering is reset to 0001 if you switch
memory cards, or when a new folder is created.
●● Regardless of the option selected in this setting, shots may be
numbered consecutively after the last number of existing images
on newly inserted memory cards. To start saving shots from 0001,
use an empty (or formatted (= 148)) memory card.
●● Refer to “Software Instruction Manual” (= 164) for information
on the card folder structure and image formats.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
149
Before Use
Date-Based Image Storage
Electronic Level Calibration
Instead of saving images in folders created each month, you can have the
camera create folders each day you shoot to store shots taken that day.
Calibrate the electronic level if it seems ineffective in helping you level the
camera.
For greater calibration accuracy, display grid lines (= 96) to help you
level the camera in advance.
●● Choose [Create Folder], and then choose
[Daily].
●● Images will now be saved in folders
created on the shooting date.
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
1 Make sure the camera is level.
●● Place the camera on a flat surface, such
as a table.
2 Calibrate the electronic level.
Metric / Non-Metric Display
Change the unit of measurement shown in GPS elevation information
(= 103, = 141), the zoom bar (= 33), the MF indicator (= 79),
and elsewhere from m/cm to ft/in as needed.
●● Choose [Units], and then choose [ft/in].
●● Choose [Electronic Level], and then press
the [ ] button.
●● Choose [Calibrate] and press the
[ ] button. A confirmation message is
displayed.
●● Choose [OK], and then press the [
button.
]
Resetting the Electronic Level
Restore the electronic level to its original state as follows. Note that this is
not possible unless you have calibrated the electronic level.
●● Choose [Electronic Level], and then press
the [ ] button.
●● Choose [Reset], and then press the [
button.
●● Choose [OK], and then press the [
button.
]
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
]
150
Setting Copyright Information to Record in Images
To record the author’s name and copyright details in images, set this
information beforehand as follows.
●● Choose [Copyright Info], and then press
the [ ] button.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose
[Enter Author’s Name] or [Enter Copyright
Details]. Press the [ ] button to access
the keyboard, and enter the name
(= 31).
] button. When [Accept
●● Press the [
changes?] is displayed, press the [ ][ ]
buttons to choose [Yes], and then press
the [ ] button.
●● The information set here will now be
recorded in images.
●● To check the information entered, choose [Display Copyright Info]
on the screen above, and then press the [ ] button.
●● You can also use the software (= 164) to enter, change, and
delete copyright information. Some characters entered with the
software may not display on the camera, but will be correctly
recorded in images.
●● You can check copyright information recorded in images by using
the software, once you save the images to a computer.
Deleting All Copyright Information
You can delete both the author’s name and copyright details at the same
time as follows.
●● Follow the steps in “Setting Copyright
Information to Record in Images”
(= 151) and choose [Delete Copyright
Info].
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose [OK],
and then press the [ ] button.
●● The copyright info already recorded in images will not be deleted.
Checking Certification Logos
Some logos for certification requirements met by the camera can be
viewed on the screen. Other certification logos are printed in this guide, on
the camera packaging, or on the camera body.
●● Choose [Certification Logo Display], and
then press the [ ] button.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
151
Before Use
Display Language
Restoring Defaults
Change the display language as needed.
If you accidentally change a setting, you can restore default camera
settings.
●● Choose [Language
the [ ] button.
], and then press
●● Press the [ ][ ][ ][ ] buttons to choose
a language, and then press the [ ]
button.
1 Access the [Reset All] screen.
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● Choose [Reset All], and then press the
[ ] button.
2 Restore default settings.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose [OK],
and then press the [ ] button.
●● You can also access the [Language] screen in Playback mode by
pressing and holding the [ ] button and immediately pressing
] button.
the [
Adjusting Other Settings
The following settings can also be adjusted on the [
●● [Video System] (= 157)
] tab.
●● Default settings are now restored.
●● The following functions are not restored to default settings.
-- Information registered using Face ID (= 47)
-- [ ] tab settings [Date/Time] (= 146), [Time Zone] (= 146),
] (= 152), and [Video System] (= 157)
[Language
-- Custom white balance data you have recorded (= 77)
-- Shooting mode (= 59)
-- Wi-Fi settings (= 122)
-- Calibrated value for the electronic level (= 150)
●● [Wi-Fi Settings] (= 122)
●● [Mobile Device Connect Button] (= 123)
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
152
9
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Accessories
Enjoy the camera in more ways with optional Canon accessories and
other compatible accessories sold separately
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
153
Before Use
System Map
Basic Guide
Flash Units
Included Accessories
Advanced Guide
Neck Strap
Battery Charger
CB-2LC/CB-2LCE*1
Battery Pack
NB-10L*1
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Speedlite*3
600EX-RT, 600EX, 580EX II, 430EX II,
320EX, 270EX II
Lens Accessories
USB Cable (camera end: Mini-B)*2
Canon-Brand Lens Filter
(67 mm dia.)*4
Power
Memory Card
Card Reader
Windows/
Macintosh
Computer
PictBridge-Compatible Printers
Other Accessories
Cables
AC Adapter Kit
ACK-DC80
Lens Hood
LH-DC90
HDMI Cable HTC-100
Remote Switch RS-60E3
Stereo AV Cable
AVC-DC400ST
TV/Video
System
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
Use of genuine Canon accessories is recommended.
*1 Also available for purchase separately.
*2 A genuine Canon accessory is also available (Interface Cable IFC-400PCU).
*3 The following accessories are also supported: Speedlite 580EX, 430EX,
270EX, and 220EX, Speedlite Transmitter ST-E2, and Speedlite Bracket
SB‑E2.
*4 Requires Filter Adapter FA‑DC67A.
This product is designed to achieve excellent performance when used
with genuine Canon accessories.
Canon shall not be liable for any damage to this product and/or accidents
such as fire, etc., caused by the malfunction of non-genuine Canon
accessories (e.g., a leakage and/or explosion of a battery pack). Please
note that this warranty does not apply to repairs arising out of the
malfunction of non-genuine Canon accessories, although you may request
such repairs on a chargeable basis.
154
Optional Accessories
Before Use
Flash Units
Basic Guide
The following camera accessories are sold separately. Note that
availability varies by area, and some accessories may no longer be
available.
Speedlite 600EX‑RT/600EX/580EX
II/430EX II/320EX/270EX II
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● Shoe-mounted flash unit that enables
many styles of flash photography.
Speedlite 580EX, 430EX, 270EX, and
220EX are also supported.
Power Supplies
Battery Pack NB-10L
Speedlite Bracket SB-E2
●● Rechargeable lithium-ion battery
●● Prevents unnatural shadows next to
subjects during vertical shooting. Includes
Off-Camera Shoe Cord OC-E3.
Battery Charger CB-2LC/CB-2LCE
●● Charger for Battery Pack NB-10L
Speedlite Transmitter ST-E2
AC Adapter Kit ACK-DC80
●● For powering the camera using
household power. Recommended when
using the camera over extended periods,
or when connecting the camera to a
printer or computer. Cannot be used to
charge the battery pack in the camera.
●● The battery charger and AC adapter kit can be used in areas with
100 – 240 V AC power (50/60 Hz).
●● For power outlets in a different format, use a commercially
available adapter for the plug. Never use an electrical transformer
designed for traveling, which may damage the battery pack.
●● Enables wireless control of slave
Speedlite flash units (except Speedlite
220EX/270EX).
Other Accessories
Interface Cable IFC-400PCU
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● For connecting the camera to a computer
or printer.
Stereo AV Cable AVC-DC400ST
●● Connect the camera to a TV to enjoy
playback on the larger TV screen.
155
HDMI Cable HTC-100
●● For connecting the camera to an HDMI
input of a high-definition TV.
Remote Switch RS-60E3
●● Enables remote shutter button operation
(pressing the button halfway or all the
way down).
Before Use
Printers
Basic Guide
Canon-Brand PictBridge-Compatible
Printers
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● Even without using a computer, you can
print images by connecting the camera
directly to a printer.
For details, visit your nearest Canon
retailer.
Lens Hood LH-DC90
●● Prevents extraneous light outside the
angle of view from entering the lens and
causing flares or ghosting, which reduce
image quality.
Filter Adapter FA-DC67A
●● Adapter required when mounting a 67
mm filter.
Canon Lens Filter (67 mm dia.)
●● Protects the lens and enables a variety of
shooting effects.
●● A lens filter and lens cap cannot be attached to the camera at the
same time.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
156
Using Optional Accessories
 Still Images  Movies
●● On the camera, open the terminal cover
and insert the cable plug fully into the
camera terminal.
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
Playback on a TV
 Still Images  Movies
By connecting the camera to a TV, you can view your shots on the larger
screen of the TV.
For details on connection or how to switch inputs, refer to the TV manual.
●● Some information may not be displayed when viewing images on
a TV (= 181).
Playback on a High-Definition TV
 Still Images 1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
 Movies
Connecting the camera to an HDTV with the HDMI Cable HTC-100 (sold
separately) enables you to view your shots on the larger screen of the TV.
Movies shot at a resolution of [
], [
], or [
] can be viewed in
high definition.
1 Make sure the camera and TV are
off.
2 Connect the camera to the TV.
3 Turn the TV on and switch to video
input.
●● Switch the TV input to the video input you
connected the cable to in step 2.
4 Turn the camera on.
●● Press the [
on.
] button to turn the camera
●● Images from the camera are now
displayed on the TV. (Nothing is
displayed on the camera screen.)
●● When finished, turn off the camera and
TV before disconnecting the cable.
●● Camera operating sounds are not played while the camera is
connected to an HDTV.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● On the TV, insert the cable plug fully into
the HDMI input as shown.
157
Playback on a Standard-Definition TV
 Still Images  Movies
Connecting the camera to a TV with the Stereo AV Cable AVC-DC400ST
(sold separately) enables you to view your shots on the larger screen of
the TV as you control the camera.
●● When the camera and TV are connected, you can also shoot
while previewing shots on the larger screen of the TV. To shoot,
follow the same steps as when using the camera screen.
However, AF-Point Zoom (= 54), MF-Point Zoom (= 79)
and MF Peaking (= 80) are not available.
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1 Make sure the camera and TV are
off.
2 Connect the camera to the TV.
●● On the TV, insert the cable plugs fully into
the video inputs as shown.
●● Make sure the cable plugs are in video
inputs of the same color.
●● On the camera, open the terminal cover
and insert the cable plug fully into the
camera terminal.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Powering the Camera with Household Power
 Still Images  Movies
Powering the camera with AC Adapter Kit ACK-DC80 (sold separately)
eliminates the need to monitor the remaining battery level.
1 Make sure the camera is off.
2 Open the cover.
●● Follow step 1 in “Inserting the Battery
Pack and Memory Card” (= 19) to
open the memory card/battery cover, and
then open the coupler cable port cover
as shown.
3 Connect the adapter to the coupler.
3 Display images.
●● Follow steps 3 – 4 in “Playback on a
High-Definition TV” (= 157) to display
images.
●● Insert the adapter plug fully into the
coupler.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● Correct display is not possible unless the camera video output
format (NTSC or PAL) matches the TV format. To change the
] button and choose
video output format, press the [
[Video System] on the [ ] tab.
158
4 Insert the coupler.
●● Insert the coupler as shown until it locks
into place.
●● Lower the cover (1), keeping the coupler
cable in the coupler cable port (2).
(1)
Using an External Microphone
An external microphone with a mini plug (3.5 mm diameter) can be
connected to the external microphone IN terminal (= 3) for use in
recording. Note that the built-in microphone is not used for recording when
an external microphone is connected.
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Open the cover and connect the
external microphone.
(2)
5 Connect the power cord.
●● Insert one end of the power cord into the
compact power adapter, and then plug
the other end into a power outlet.
●● Turn the camera on and use it as desired.
●● Any attenuator settings you have configured are also applied to
recording with the external microphone (= 69).
●● Connecting an external microphone will deactivate [Wind Filter]
(= 69).
●● When finished, turn the camera off and
unplug the power cord from the outlet.
●● Do not disconnect the adapter or unplug the power cord while
the camera is still on. This may erase your shots or damage the
camera.
●● Do not attach the adapter or adapter cord to other objects. Doing
so could result in malfunction or damage to the product.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
159
Using a Lens Hood (Sold Separately)
 Still Images  Movies
For wide-angle shots of backlit subjects without using the flash, attach
optional Lens Hood LH-DC90 to prevent light outside the angle of view
from entering the lens.
●● Make sure the camera is off.
(1)
(2)
Before Use
Using Lens Filters (Sold Separately)
●● Align the lens hood mark (2) with the
camera mark (1), and turn the lens hood
in the direction of the arrow until it locks
in place.
●● To remove the lens hood, turn it in the
opposite direction.
 Still Images  Movies
Attaching a lens filter to the camera protects the lens and allows you
to shoot with various effects. To attach a lens filter, you will need Filter
Adapter FA-DC67A (sold separately).
1
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Attach the filter adapter.
●● Make sure the camera is off.
●● Align the notches on the camera and the
filter adapter and turn the adapter in the
direction of the arrow until locked.
●● To remove the filter adapter, turn it in the
opposite direction.
2 Attach a filter.
●● Turn the filter in the direction of the arrow
to attach it to the camera.
(1)
(2)
●● To attach the lens hood inverted (as
shown) when the hood is not used, align
the lens hood mark (2) with the camera
mark (1), and turn the lens hood in the
direction of the arrow until it locks in
place.
●● Vignetting may occur if you use the built-in flash when the lens
hood is attached.
●● The filter adapter and a lens hood cannot be attached to the
camera at the same time.
●● Make sure not to attach the filter too
tightly. Doing so could prevent removal of
the filter and damage the camera.
●● We recommend the use of genuine Canon filters (67 mm dia.).
●● When not using auto focus to shoot, set the manual focus option
[Safety MF] to [On].
●● If you use the built-in flash with the filter adapter attached,
portions of the image may appear darker.
●● When using the filter adapter, be sure to use only one filter at a
time. Attaching multiple filters, or accessories such as a heavy
lens, may cause the attachments to fall off and become damaged.
●● Do not grip the filter adapter tightly.
●● Remove the filter adapter when not using a filter.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
160
●● The filter adapter and a lens hood cannot be attached to the
camera at the same time.
 Still Images  Movies
More sophisticated flash photography is possible with an optional
Speedlite EX series flash. For movie shooting using an LED light, the
optional Speedlite 320EX flash is available.
Using a Remote Switch (Sold Separately)
 Still Images Before Use
Using an External Flash (Sold Separately)
 Movies
An optional Remote Switch RS-60E3 can be used to avoid camera shake
that may otherwise occur when pressing the shutter button directly. This
optional accessory is convenient when shooting at slow shutter speeds.
1 Connect the remote switch.
●● Make sure the camera is off.
●● Open the terminal cover and insert the
remote switch plug.
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● This camera does not support some Speedlite EX series
functions.
●● Wireless operation of the Speedlite 600EX-RT is not supported.
●● Non-EX series Canon flash units may not fire correctly or may not
fire at all, in some cases.
●● Use of non-Canon flash units (especially high-voltage flash units)
or flash accessories may prevent normal camera operation and
may damage the camera.
●● Also refer to the Speedlite EX series manual for additional
information.
2 Shoot.
●● To shoot, press the release button on the
remote switch.
●● Bulb photography (long exposures) is not supported.
Speedlite EX Series
 Still Images  Movies
These optional flash units can provide bright lighting and meet a variety of
flash photography needs.
1 Attach the flash.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● Make sure the camera is off, and then
attach the flash unit to the hot shoe.
161
2 Turn the flash on, and then turn the
camera on.
●● A red [ ] icon is now displayed.
●● The flash pilot lamp will light up when the
flash is ready.
3 Choose shooting mode [
[
], or [
].
], [
],
●● Flash settings can only be configured in
these modes. In other modes, the flash
is adjusted and fired automatically, as
needed.
4 Set the white balance to [
(= 76).
]
5 Configure the external flash.
●● Press the [
Control] on the [
the [ ] button.
] button, choose [Flash
] tab, and then press
●● Options already set on the flash itself are
displayed.
●● Settings for the built-in flash cannot be configured while a
Speedlite EX series flash is attached, because that setting screen
is no longer accessible.
●● You can also access the setting screen by pressing the [ ] button
for at least one second.
] shooting mode can be configured just as
●● Flash settings in [
they are in [ ] mode.
●● 600EX-RT/580EX II only: [Flash Control] is not available if the
external flash has been set up for stroboscopic flash.
●● 320EX only: Auto LED lighting is only available in low-light movie
recording or in Movie mode. In this case, the [ ] icon is shown.
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Using Speedlite Bracket SB-E2 (Sold Separately)
 Still Images  Movies
●● Using the optional Speedlite Bracket SBE2 can help prevent unnatural shadows
next to subjects during vertical shooting.
●● To keep the LCD screen out of the way
of the bracket, use the screen closed and
facing outward.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose an
item, and then press the [ ][ ] buttons to
adjust the setting.
●● Available items vary depending on the
shooting mode and the flash attached
(= 163).
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
162
Camera Settings Available with an External Flash
(Sold Separately)
 Still Images  Movies
The following items are available in [ ], [
], [
], or [ ] mode. In
other shooting modes, only [Red-Eye Corr.] and [Red-Eye Lamp] can
be configured. (With autoflash control, the flash always fires.) However,
external flash units do not fire in modes that the built-in flash does not fire
(= 182).
Shooting Mode
Item
Flash Mode
Flash Exp.
Comp*3
Options
Auto*1
O
O
O
–
Manual*2
O
O
O
O
–3 to +3
O
O
O
–
5
Flash Output*4
1/128* to 1/1 (in 1/3-stop
increments)
O
O
O
O
Shutter Sync.
1st-curtain/2nd-curtain/Hispeed
O
O
O
O
On
O
O
O
O
Slow Synchro
Off
O
–
O
–
Wireless Func.*6
On/Off
O
O
O
O
Red-Eye Corr.
On/Off
O
O
O
O
Red-Eye Lamp
On/Off
O
O
O
O
On
O
O
O
–
Off
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
Safety FE*7
Clear Flash Settings*8
*3 Can be configured only when [Flash Mode] is [Auto] and flash exposure
compensation set on the flash is [+0]. When you adjust flash exposure
compensation on 600EX-RT, 600EX, 580EX II, or 430EX II Speedlites, the
camera display will be updated accordingly.
*4 Can be configured when [Flash Mode] is [Manual]. Linked to settings on the
flash unit.
*5 1/64 for Speedlite 430EX II/430EX/320EX/270EX II/270EX.
*6 For options other than On/Off, configure the setting on the flash unit itself. Not
available with Speedlite 430EX II/320EX/270EX II/270EX. When this item is set
to [On], [Shutter Sync.] cannot be set to [2nd-curtain]. (If [Shutter Sync.] is set to
[2nd-curtain], it will be changed to [1st-curtain].)
*7 Can only be configured when [Flash Mode] is [Auto].
*8 Restores all default settings. You can also restore defaults for [Slow Synchro],
[Safety FE], [Red-Eye Corr.], and [Red-Eye Lamp] by using [Reset All] on the
[ ] tab on the camera (= 152).
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● Flash settings in [
] shooting mode can be configured just as
they are in [ ] mode.
] shooting mode, icons representing Smiling, Sleeping,
●● In [
Babies (Smiling), Babies (Sleeping), and Children shooting
scenes determined by the camera are not displayed, and the
camera does not shoot continuously (= 38).
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
*1 E-TTL mode is used for the flash.
*2 M mode is used for the flash.
In [ ] shooting mode, E-TTL mode is also available for the flash. In this case,
when the flash fires, flash exposure compensation set on the flash is applied to
the flash output level set on the camera.
163
Using the Software
The software available for download from the Canon website is introduced
below, with instructions for installation and saving images to a computer.
Software
After downloading the software from the Canon website and installing it,
you can do the following things on your computer.
●● CameraWindow
-- Import images and change camera settings
●● ImageBrowser EX
-- Manage images: view, search, and organize
-- Print and edit images
●● Digital Photo Professional
-- Browse, process and edit RAW images
Before Use
Computer Connections via a Cable
Basic Guide
Checking Your Computer Environment
Advanced Guide
The software can be used on the following computers. For detailed
system requirements and compatibility information, including support in
new operating systems, visit the Canon website.
Operating
System*
Windows
Windows 8/8.1
Windows 7 SP1
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Mac OS
Mac OS X 10.9
Mac OS X 10.8
* When sending images to a computer via Wi-Fi, check the system requirements in
“Checking Your Computer Environment” (= 127).
●● Check the Canon website for the latest system requirements,
including supported OS versions.
Installing the Software
●● Internet access is required, and any ISP account charges and
access fees must be paid separately.
For software installation instructions, see “Installing the Software”
(= 127).
Software Instruction Manual
Refer to the instruction manual when using the software. The manual can
be accessed from the help system of software (some software excluded).
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
164
●● Choose [Downloads Images From Canon
Camera] and then click [OK].
Saving Images to a Computer
Before Use
Basic Guide
Windows 7 and Mac OS X 10.8 are used here for the sake of illustration.
For other functions, refer to the help system of the relevant software
(some software excluded).
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
1 Connect the camera to the
computer.
(2)
(1)
●● Double-click [
●● With the camera turned off, open the
cover (1). With the smaller plug of the
USB cable in the orientation shown,
insert the plug fully into the camera
terminal (2).
].
3 Save the images to the computer.
●● Click [Import Images from Camera], and
then click [Import Untransferred Images].
●● Insert the larger plug of the USB cable
in the computer’s USB port. For details
about USB connections on the computer,
refer to the computer user manual.
2 Turn the camera on to access
●● After images are saved, close
] button to
CameraWindow, press the [
turn the camera off, and unplug the cable.
●● For instructions on viewing images on a
computer, refer to “Software Instruction
Manual” (= 164).
CameraWindow.
●● Press the [
on.
●● Images are now saved to the Pictures
folder on the computer, in separate
folders named by date.
] button to turn the camera
●● Mac OS: CameraWindow is displayed
when a connection is established
between the camera and computer.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● Windows: Follow the steps introduced
below.
●● In the screen that displays, click the [
link to modify the program.
]
165
●● Windows 7: If the screen in step 2 is not displayed, click the [ ]
icon in the taskbar.
●● Mac OS: If CameraWindow is not displayed after step 2, click the
[CameraWindow] icon in the Dock.
●● Although you can save images to a computer simply by
connecting your camera to the computer without using the
software, the following limitations apply.
-- It may take a few minutes after you connect the camera to the
computer until camera images are accessible.
-- Images shot in vertical orientation may be saved in horizontal
orientation.
-- RAW images (or JPEG images recorded with RAW images)
may not be saved.
-- Image protection settings may be cleared from images saved
to a computer.
-- Some problems may occur when saving images or image
information, depending on the operating system version, the
software in use, or image file sizes.
-- Some functions provided by the software may not be available,
such as movie editing.
Before Use
Printing Images
 Still Images  Movies
Your shots can easily be printed by connecting the camera to a printer.
On the camera, you can specify images to set up batch printing, prepare
orders for photo development services, and prepare orders or print
images for photobooks.
A Canon SELPHY CP series compact photo printer is used here for the
sake of illustration. Screens displayed and available functions vary by
printer. Also refer to the printer manual for additional information.
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Easy Print
 Still Images  Movies
Easily print your shots by connecting the camera to a PictBridgecompatible printer (sold separately) with the USB cable.
1 Make sure the camera and printer
are off.
2 Connect the camera to the printer.
●● Open the terminal cover. Holding the
smaller cable plug in the orientation
shown, insert the plug fully into the
camera terminal.
●● Connect the larger cable plug to the
printer. For other connection details, refer
to the printer manual.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
166
3 Turn the printer on.
4 Turn the camera on.
●● Press the [
on.
 Still Images ] button to turn the camera
 Movies
1 Access the printing screen.
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● After following steps 1 – 5 in “Easy Print”
(= 166) to choose an image, press the
[ ] button to access this screen.
5 Choose an image.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose an
image.
2 Configure the settings.
6 Print the image.
●● Press the [
Before Use
Configuring Print Settings
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose an
item, and then press the [ ][ ] buttons to
choose an option.
] button.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose
[Print], and then press the [ ] button.
Default
Date
●● Printing now begins.
File No.
●● To print other images, repeat the above
procedures starting from step 5 after
printing is finished.
Both
●● When you are finished printing, turn the
camera and printer off and disconnect
the cable.
Off
Default
●● For Canon-brand PictBridge-compatible printers (sold separately),
see “Printers” (= 156).
●● RAW images cannot be printed.
Matches current printer settings.
Prints images with the date added.
Prints images with the file number added.
Prints images with both the date and file
number added.
–
Matches current printer settings.
Off
–
On
Uses information from the time of shooting to
print under optimal settings.
Red-Eye 1 Corrects red-eye.
No. of
Copies
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
Choose the number of copies to print.
Cropping
–
Specify a desired image area to print (= 168).
Paper
Settings
–
Specify the paper size, layout, and other details
(= 168).
167
Cropping Images before Printing
Choosing Paper Size and Layout before Printing
 Still Images  Movies
By cropping images before printing, you can print a desired image area
instead of the entire image.
1 Choose [Cropping].
●● After following step 1 in “Configuring Print
Settings” (= 167) to access the printing
screen, choose [Cropping] and press the
[ ] button.
●● A cropping frame is now displayed,
indicating the image area to print.
2 Adjust the cropping frame as
 Still Images  Movies
1 Choose [Paper Settings].
●● After following step 1 in “Configuring Print
Settings” (= 167) to access the printing
screen, choose [Paper Settings] and
press the [ ] button.
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
2 Choose a paper size.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose an
option, and then press the [ ] button.
needed.
●● To resize the frame, move the zoom
lever.
●● To move the frame, press the
[ ][ ][ ][ ] buttons.
●● To rotate the frame, press the [
3 Choose a type of paper.
] button.
] button, press the
●● Press the [
[ ][ ] buttons to choose [OK], and then
press the [ ] button.
3 Print the image.
●● Follow step 6 in “Easy Print” (= 166)
to print.
●● Cropping may not be possible at small image sizes, or at some
aspect ratios.
●● Dates may not be printed correctly if you crop images shot with
] selected.
[Date Stamp
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose an
option, and then press the [ ] button.
4 Choose a layout.
●● Press the [
option.
][
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
] buttons to choose an
●● When choosing [N-up], press the [ ][ ]
buttons to specify the number of images
per sheet.
●● Press the [
] button.
5 Print the image.
168
Available Layout Options
Default
Matches current printer settings.
Bordered
Prints with blank space around the image.
 Still Images  Movies
Borderless, edge-to-edge printing.
N-up
Choose how many images to print per sheet.
ID Photo
Prints images for identification purposes.
Only available for images with a resolution of L and an
aspect ratio of 4:3.
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1 Access the printing screen.
Borderless
Fixed Size
Before Use
Printing Movie Scenes
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● Follow steps 1 – 5 in “Easy Print”
(= 166) to choose a movie, and then
press the [ ] button.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose
[ ], and then press the [ ] button. This
screen is displayed.
Choose the print size.
Choose from 3.5 x 5 in., postcard, or wide-format prints.
2 Choose a printing method.
Printing ID Photos
 Still Images ●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose [
and then press the [ ][ ] buttons to
choose the printing method.
 Movies
1 Choose [ID Photo].
●● Following steps 1 – 4 in “Choosing
Paper Size and Layout before Printing”
(= 168), choose [ID Photo] and press
the [ ] button.
2 Choose the long and short side length.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose an
item. Choose the length by pressing the
[ ][ ] buttons, and then press the [ ]
button.
3 Choose the printing area.
●● Follow step 2 in “Cropping Images before
Printing” (= 168) to choose the printing
area.
],
3 Print the image.
Movie Printing Options
Single
Prints the current scene as a still image.
Prints a series of scenes, a certain interval apart, on a single
sheet of paper. You can also print the folder number, file
Sequence
number, and elapsed time for the frame by setting [Caption]
to [On].
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● To cancel printing in progress, press the [ ] button, choose [OK],
and then press the [ ] button again.
●● [ID Photo] and [Sequence] cannot be chosen on Canon-brand
PictBridge-compatible printers from CP720/CP730 and earlier
models.
4 Print the image.
169
Adding Images to the Print List (DPOF)
 Still Images  Movies
Batch printing (= 172) and ordering prints from a photo development
service can be set up on the camera. Choose up to 998 images on a
memory card and configure relevant settings, such as the number of
copies, as follows. The printing information you prepare this way will
conform to DPOF (Digital Print Order Format) standards.
Print Type
Date
File No.
●● RAW images cannot be included in print list.
Clear DPOF
data
Configuring Print Settings
 Still Images One image is printed per sheet.
Before Use
Index
Smaller versions of multiple images are
printed per sheet.
Basic Guide
Both
Both standard and index formats are
printed.
Advanced Guide
Standard
On
Images are printed with the shooting date.
Off
–
On
Images are printed with the file number.
Off
–
On
All image print list settings are cleared after
printing.
Off
–
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
 Movies
Specify the printing format, whether to add the date or file number, and
other settings as follows. These settings apply to all images in the print
list.
●● Press the [
] button, and then
choose [Print Settings] on the [ ] tab.
Choose and configure items as desired
(= 30).
●● Not all of your DPOF settings may be applied in printing by the
printer or photo development service, in some cases.
●● [ ] may be displayed on the camera to warn you that the
memory card has print settings that were configured on another
camera. Changing the print settings using this camera may
overwrite all previous settings.
●● Setting [Date] to [On] may cause some printers to print the date
twice.
●● Specifying [Index] will prevent you from choosing [On] for both
[Date] and [File No.] at the same time.
●● Index printing is not available on some Canon-brand PictBridgecompatible printers (sold separately).
●● The date is printed in a format matching setting details in [Date/
Time] on the [ ] tab (= 20).
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
170
Setting Up Printing for Individual Images
 Still Images Setting Up Printing for a Range of Images
 Movies
1 Choose [Select Images & Qty.].
●● Press the [
] button, choose
[Select Images & Qty.] on the [ ] tab,
and then press the [ ] button.
2 Choose an image.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose an
image, and then press the [ ] button.
●● You can now specify the number of
copies.
●● If you specify index printing for the
image, it is labeled with a [ ] icon. To
cancel index printing for the image, press
the [ ] button again. [ ] is no longer
displayed.
3 Specify the number of prints.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to specify the
number of prints (up to 99).
●● To set up printing for other images and
specify the number of prints, repeat steps
2 – 3.
●● Printing quantity cannot be specified for
index prints. You can only choose which
images to print, by following step 2.
●● When finished, press the [
to return to the menu screen.
 Still Images Before Use
 Movies
●● Following step 1 in “Setting Up Printing
for Individual Images” (= 171), choose
[Select Range] and press the [ ] button.
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● Follow steps 2 – 3 in “Selecting a Range”
(= 111) to specify images.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose
[Order], and then press the [ ] button.
Setting Up Printing for All Images
 Still Images  Movies
●● Following step 1 in “Setting Up Printing
for Individual Images” (= 171), choose
[Select All Images] and press the [ ]
button.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose [OK],
and then press the [ ] button.
Clearing All Images from the Print List
●● Following step 1 in “Setting Up Printing
for Individual Images” (= 171), choose
[Clear All Selections] and press the [ ]
button.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose [OK],
and then press the [ ] button.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
] button
171
Printing Images Added to the Print List (DPOF)
 Still Images  Movies
●● When images have been added to the
print list (= 170 – = 171), this screen
is displayed after you connect the camera
to a PictBridge-compatible printer. Press
the [ ][ ] buttons to choose [Print now],
and then simply press the [ ] button to
print the images in the print list.
●● Any DPOF print job that you temporarily
stop will be resumed from the next image.
Adding Images to a Photobook
 Still Images  Movies
Photobooks can be set up on the camera by choosing up to 998 images
on a memory card and importing them into the software on your computer,
where they are stored in their own folder. This is convenient when
ordering printed photobooks online or printing photobooks with your own
printer.
Choosing a Selection Method
●● Press the [
] button, choose
[Photobook Set-up] on the [
] tab, and
then choose how you will select images.
●● After importing images to your computer, also refer to “Software
Instruction Manual” (= 164) and the printer manual for further
information.
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
Adding Images Individually
 Still Images 1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
 Movies
1 Choose [Select].
●● Following the procedure in “Choosing
a Selection Method” (= 172), choose
[Select] and press the [ ] button.
2 Choose an image.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose an
image, and then press the [ ] button.
●● [
] is displayed.
●● To remove the image from the photobook,
press the [ ] button again. [ ] is no
longer displayed.
●● Repeat this process to specify other
images.
●● When finished, press the [
to return to the menu screen.
] button
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● [ ] may be displayed on the camera to warn you that the
memory card has print settings that were configured on another
camera. Changing the print settings using this camera may
overwrite all previous settings.
172
Adding All Images to a Photobook
Before Use
 Still Images  Movies
●● Following the procedure in “Choosing
a Selection Method” (= 172), choose
[Select All Images] and press the [ ]
button.
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose [OK],
and then press the [ ] button.
Removing All Images from a Photobook
 Still Images  Movies
●● Following the procedure in “Choosing
a Selection Method” (= 172), choose
[Clear All Selections] and press the [ ]
button.
●● Press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose [OK],
and then press the [ ] button.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
173
10
Appendix
Helpful information when using the camera
Troubleshooting
If you think there is a problem with the camera, first check the following.
If the items below do not solve your problem, contact a Canon Customer
Support Help Desk.
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Power
Nothing happens when the power button is pressed.
●●
●●
●●
●●
Confirm that the battery pack is charged (= 18).
Confirm that the battery pack is inserted facing the correct way (= 19).
Confirm that the memory card/battery cover is fully closed (= 19).
Dirty battery terminals reduce battery performance. Try cleaning the terminals
with a cotton swab and reinserting the battery pack a few times.
The battery pack runs out of power quickly.
●● Battery performance decreases at low temperatures. Try warming the battery
pack a little by putting it in your pocket, for example, ensuring that the terminals
do not touch any metal objects.
●● Dirty battery terminals reduce battery performance. Try cleaning the terminals
with a cotton swab and reinserting the battery pack a few times.
●● If these measures do not help and the battery pack still runs out of power soon
after charging, it has reached the end of its life. Purchase a new battery pack.
The lens is not retracted.
●● Do not open the memory card/battery cover while the camera is on. Close the
cover, turn the camera on, and then turn it off again (= 19).
The battery pack is swollen.
●● Battery swelling is normal and does not pose any safety concerns. However, if
battery swelling prevents the battery pack from fitting in the camera, contact a
Canon Customer Support Help Desk.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
Display on a TV
Camera images look distorted or not displayed on a TV (= 157).
174
Shooting
Subjects in shots look too dark.
Raise the flash and set the flash mode to [ ] (= 86).
Adjust brightness by using exposure compensation (= 72).
Adjust contrast by using i-Contrast (= 75, = 118).
Use AE lock or spot metering (= 72).
●● In Playback mode (= 101), press the shutter button halfway (= 26).
●●
●●
●●
●●
Nothing is displayed (= 36).
Subjects look too bright, highlights are washed-out.
Cannot shoot.
Strange display on the screen under low light (= 28).
Strange display on the screen when shooting.
●● Note that the following display problems are not recorded in still images but are
recorded in movies.
-- The screen may flicker and horizontal banding may appear under fluorescent
or LED lighting.
No date stamp is added to images.
●● Configure the [Date Stamp
] setting (= 20). Note that date stamps are not
added to images automatically, merely because you have configured the [Date/
Time] setting (= 45).
●● Date stamps are not added in shooting modes (= 187) in which this setting
cannot be configured (= 45).
[ ] flashes on the screen when the shutter button is pressed, and shooting
is not possible (= 36).
[
●●
●●
●●
●●
] is displayed when the shutter button is pressed halfway (= 36).
Set [IS Mode] to [Continuous] (= 90).
Raise the flash and set the flash mode to [ ] (= 86).
Increase the ISO speed (= 73).
Mount the camera on a tripod or take other measures to keep it still. Additionally,
you should set [IS Mode] to [Off] when using a tripod or other means to secure
the camera (= 90).
Shots are out of focus.
●●
●●
●●
●●
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
Lower the flash and set the flash mode to [ ] (= 33).
Adjust brightness by using exposure compensation (= 72).
Use AE lock or spot metering (= 72).
Reduce the lighting on subjects.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Shots look too dark despite the flash firing (= 36).
●● Shoot within flash range (= 198).
●● Adjust brightness by using flash exposure compensation or changing the flash
output level (= 87, = 94).
●● Increase the ISO speed (= 73).
Subjects in flash shots look too bright, highlights are washed-out.
●● Shoot within flash range (= 198).
●● Lower the flash and set the flash mode to [ ] (= 33).
●● Adjust brightness by using flash exposure compensation or changing the flash
output level (= 87, = 94).
White spots appear in flash shots.
●● This is caused by light from the flash reflecting off dust or airborne particles.
Shots look grainy.
●● Lower the ISO speed (= 73).
●● High ISO speeds in some shooting modes may cause grainy images (= 59).
Subjects are affected by red-eye (= 52).
●● Set [Red-Eye Lamp] to [On] (= 55). The red-eye reduction lamp (= 3) will
be activated in flash shots. For best results, have subjects look at the red-eye
reduction lamp. Also try increasing the lighting in indoor scenes and shooting at
closer range.
●● Edit images using red-eye correction (= 119).
●● Press the shutter button halfway to focus on subjects before pressing it all the
way down to shoot (= 26).
●● Make sure subjects are within focusing range (= 198).
●● Set [AF-assist Beam] to [On] (= 55).
●● Confirm that unneeded functions such as macro are deactivated.
●● Try shooting with focus lock or AF lock (= 82, = 85).
Recording to the memory card takes too long, or continuous shooting is
slower.
No AF frames are displayed and the camera does not focus when the
shutter button is pressed halfway.
Shooting settings or FUNC. menu settings are not available.
●● To have AF frames displayed and the camera focus correctly, try composing the
shot with higher-contrast subject areas centered before you press the shutter
button halfway. Otherwise, try pressing the shutter button halfway repeatedly.
Before Use
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● Use the camera to perform low-level formatting of the memory card (= 149).
●● Available setting items vary by shooting mode. Refer to “Functions Available in
Each Shooting Mode”, “FUNC. Menu”, and “Shooting Tab” (= 182 – = 187).
175
The Babies or Children icon does not display.
●● The Babies and Children icons will not display if the birthday is not set in face
information (= 47). If the icons still do not display even when you set the
birthday, re-register face information (= 47), or make sure that the date/time
are set correctly (= 146).
Sound is not played during movies.
●● Adjust the volume (= 145) if you have activated [Mute] (= 145) or the sound
in the movie is faint.
●● No sound is played for movies shot in [ ] (= 62) or [ ] (= 70) mode, or
when [Sound rec.] is set to [Disable] (= 37), because audio is not recorded.
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
Shooting Movies
Memory Card
The elapsed time shown is incorrect, or recording is interrupted.
●● Use the camera to format the memory card, or switch to a card that supports
high-speed recording. Note that even if the elapsed time display is incorrect, the
length of movies on the memory card corresponds to the actual recording time
(= 148, = 198).
[
] is displayed and shooting stops automatically.
●● The camera’s internal memory buffer filled up as the camera could not record to
the memory card quickly enough. Try one of the following measures.
-- Use the camera to perform low-level formatting of the memory card (= 149).
-- Lower the image quality (= 53).
-- Switch to a memory card that supports high-speed recording (= 198).
Zooming is not possible.
●● Zooming is not possible when shooting movies in [
(= 70) modes.
] (= 62) and [
]
Subjects look distorted.
●● Subjects that pass in front of the camera quickly may look distorted. This is not a
malfunction.
Playback
Playback is not possible.
●● Image or movie playback may not be possible if a computer is used to rename
files or alter the folder structure. Refer to “Software Instruction Manual” (= 164)
for details on folder structure and file names.
Playback stops, or audio skips.
●● Switch to a memory card that you have performed low-level formatting on with the
camera (= 149).
●● There may be brief interruptions when playing movies copied to memory cards
that have slow read speeds.
●● When movies are played on a computer, frames may be dropped and audio may
skip if computer performance is inadequate.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
The memory card is not recognized.
●● Restart the camera, with the memory card in it (= 25).
Computer
Cannot transfer images to a computer.
●● When attempting to transfer images to the computer via a cable, try reducing the
transfer speed as follows.
] button to enter Playback mode. Hold the [
] button
-- Press the [
down as you press the [ ] and [ ] buttons at the same time. On the next
screen, press the [ ][ ] buttons to choose [B], and then press the [ ] button.
Wi-Fi
Cannot access the Wi-Fi menu by pressing the [
] button.
●● The Wi-Fi menu is not available in Shooting mode. Switch to Playback mode and
try again.
●● In Playback mode, the Wi-Fi menu cannot be accessed during detailed
information display, magnified display, or index display. Switch to single-image
display and a viewing mode other than detailed information display. Similarly, the
Wi-Fi menu cannot be accessed during group playback or filtered image display
according to specified conditions. Cancel group or filtered image playback.
●● The Wi-Fi menu cannot be accessed while the camera is connected to a printer,
computer, or TV via a cable. Disconnect the cable.
●● [ ] will not be displayed even in playback mode, when using magnified display
or index display. Switch to single-image display and try again. [ ] will also not
be displayed when an image is displayed by specifying search conditions. Cancel
filtered image playback.
●● [ ] will not be displayed when the camera is connected to a printer or computer
with a cable. Disconnect the cable.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
176
Cannot add a device/destination.
●● A total of 20 items of connection information can be added to the camera. Erase
unneeded connection information from the camera first, and then add new
devices/destinations (= 143).
●● Use a computer or smartphone to register Web services (= 133).
●● To add a smartphone, first install the dedicated application CameraWindow on
your smartphone (= 123).
●● To add a computer, first install the software CameraWindow on your computer.
Also check your computer and Wi-Fi environment and settings (= 127, = 129).
●● Do not use the camera near sources of Wi-Fi signal interference, such as
microwave ovens, Bluetooth devices, or other equipment operating on the 2.4
GHz band.
●● Bring the camera closer to the other device you are trying to connect to (such as
the access point), and make sure there are no objects between the devices.
Images take a long time to send./The wireless connection is disrupted.
●● Multiple images may take a long time to send. Try resizing the image to [ ] or
[ ] to reduce sending time (= 139).
●● Movies may take a long time to send.
●● Do not use the camera near sources of Wi-Fi signal interference, such as
microwave ovens, Bluetooth devices, or other equipment operating on the 2.4
] is
GHz band. Note that images may take a long time to send even when [
displayed.
●● Bring the camera closer to the other device you are trying to connect to (such as
the access point), and make sure there are no objects between the devices.
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Want to erase Wi-Fi connection information before disposing of the
camera or giving it to someone else.
●● Reset the Wi-Fi settings (= 144).
Cannot connect to the access point.
●● Confirm that the access point channel is set to a channel supported by the
camera (= 196). Note that instead of auto channel assignment, it is advisable to
specify a supported channel manually.
Cannot send images.
●● The destination device has insufficient storage space. Increase the storage space
on the destination device and resend the images.
●● The write-protect tab of the memory card in the destination camera is set to the
locked position. Slide the write-protect tab to the unlocked position.
●● RAW images cannot be sent. In [ ] mode, only the JPEG images are sent.
However, RAW images can be sent using Image Sync.
●● Images are not sent to CANON iMAGE GATEWAY or other Web services if you
move or rename image files or folders on the computer that received images sent
using Image Sync via an access point (= 139). Before moving or renaming
these image files or folders on the computer, make sure the images have already
been sent to CANON iMAGE GATEWAY or other Web services.
Cannot resize images for sending.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● Images cannot be resized to be bigger than the resolution setting of their original
size.
●● Movies cannot be resized.
177
On-Screen Messages
If an error message is displayed, respond as follows.
Capture or Playback
No memory card
●● The memory card may be inserted facing the wrong way. Reinsert the memory
card facing the correct way (= 19).
Memory card locked
●● The write-protect tab of the memory card is set to the locked position. Switch the
write-protect tab to the unlocked position (= 19).
Cannot record!
●● Shooting was attempted without a memory card in the camera. To shoot, insert a
memory card facing the correct way (= 19).
Memory card error (= 149)
●● If the same error message is displayed even after you have formatted a
supported memory card (= 2) and have inserted it facing the correct way
(= 19), contact a Canon Customer Support Help Desk.
Insufficient space on card
●● There is not enough free space on the memory card to shoot (= 33, = 57,
= 71, = 92) or edit images (= 116). Either erase unneeded images
(= 112) or insert a memory card with enough free space (= 19).
Charge the battery (= 18)
No Image.
●● The memory card does not contain any images that can be displayed.
Protected! (= 110)
Unidentified Image/Incompatible JPEG/Image too large./Cannot play back
MOV
●● Unsupported or corrupt images cannot be displayed.
●● It may not be possible to display images that were edited or renamed on a
computer, or images shot with another camera.
Cannot magnify!/Cannot play back this content in Smart Shuffle/Cannot
rotate/Cannot modify image/Cannot modify/Cannot assign to category/
Unselectable image./No identification information
●● The following functions may be unavailable for images that were renamed or
already edited on a computer, or images shot with another camera. Note that
starred (*) functions are not available for movies.
Edit ID Info* (= 107), Magnify* (= 108), Smart Shuffle* (= 110), Rotate*
(= 114), Favorites (= 115), Edit* (= 116), Print List* (= 170), and
Photobook Set-up* (= 172).
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Invalid selection range
●● When specifying a range for image selection (= 111, = 113, = 171), you
attempted to choose an initial image that was after the final image, or vice-versa.
Exceeded selection limit
●● More than 998 images were selected for Print List (= 170) or Photobook Set-up
(= 172). Choose 998 images or less.
●● Print List (= 170) or Photobook Set-up (= 172) settings could not be saved
correctly. Reduce the number of selected images and try again.
●● You attempted to choose more than 500 images in Protect (= 110), Erase
(= 112), Favorites (= 115), Print List (= 170), or Photobook Set-up
(= 172).
Naming error!
●● The folder could not be created or images could not be recorded, because the
highest supported folder number (999) for storing images on the card has been
reached and the highest supported image number (9999) for images in folders
has been reached. On the [ ] tab, change [File Numbering] to [Auto Reset]
(= 149), or format the memory card (= 148).
Lens Error
●● This error may occur if the lens is held while it is moving, or when the camera is
used in dusty or sandy locations.
●● Frequent display of this error message may indicate camera damage. In this
case, contact a Canon Customer Support Help Desk.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
A camera error was detected (error number)
●● If this error message is displayed immediately after a shot, the image may not
have been saved. Switch to Playback mode to check for the image.
●● Frequent display of this error message may indicate camera damage. In this
case, write down the error number (Exx) and contact a Canon Customer Support
Help Desk.
178
File Error
●● Correct printing (= 166) may not be possible for photos from other cameras or
images that have been altered using computer software, even if the camera is
connected to the printer.
Print error
●● Check the paper size setting (= 168). If this error message is displayed when
the setting is correct, restart the printer and complete the setting on the camera
again.
Ink absorber full
●● Contact a Canon Customer Support Help Desk to request assistance with ink
absorber replacement.
Wi-Fi
Connection failed
●● No access points were recognized. Check the access point settings (= 129).
●● A device could not be found. Turn the camera off and on again, and retry the
connection.
●● Check the device you want to connect to and make sure it is ready for connection.
Sending failed
Memory card error
●● If the same error message is displayed even when you have inserted a formatted
memory card facing the correct way, contact a Canon Customer Support Help
Desk.
Receiving failed
Insufficient space on card
Receiving failed
Naming error!
●● When the highest folder number (999), and the highest image number (9999)
have been reached on the receiving camera, images cannot be received.
Insufficient space on server
Check network settings
●● Check the access point security settings (= 129).
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● The write-protect tab of the memory card in the camera to receive the images is
set to the locked position. Slide the write-protect tab to the unlocked position.
No access points found
Incorrect password/Incorrect Wi-Fi security settings
Advanced Guide
Receiving failed
Memory card locked
●● Delete unnecessary images uploaded to CANON iMAGE GATEWAY to create
space.
●● Save the images sent via Image Sync (= 139) to your computer.
●● Check to make sure that the access point is turned on.
●● When connecting to an access point manually, make sure that you entered the
correct SSID.
Basic Guide
●● There is not enough free space on the memory card in the target camera to
receive images. Erase images to create space on the memory card, or insert a
memory card with sufficient space.
●● The WPS buttons on numerous access points were pressed simultaneously. Try
reconnecting again.
Cannot determine access point
Before Use
●● Check to make sure your computer can connect to the Internet with the current
network settings.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
IP address conflict
●● Reset the IP address so that it does not conflict with another.
Disconnected/Receiving failed/Sending failed
●● You may be in an environment where Wi-Fi signals are obstructed.
●● Avoid using the camera’s Wi-Fi function around microwave ovens, Bluetooth
devices, and other devices that operate on the 2.4 GHz band.
●● Bring the camera closer to the other device you are trying to connect to (such as
the access point), and make sure there are no objects between the devices.
●● Check the connected device to make sure it is not experiencing errors.
179
(17) Digital zoom magnification
(= 40), Digital tele-converter
(= 81)
On-Screen Information
(18) Remaining time (= 198)
Shooting (Information Display)
(19) Histogram (= 103)
(20) Focusing range (= 79), AF lock
(= 85)
The same information is shown on the viewfinder.
(33)
(11)(12)(13)(14) (15)(16)(17)(18) (19)
(20)
(21)
(1)
(32)
(8)
(9)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
(7)
(34)
(22)
(35) (36) (37)
(21) Blink detection (= 55)
(25)
(26) (27) (28) (29)
(1)
Shooting mode (= 182), Scene
icon (= 37)
(2)
Flash mode (= 86), LED light
(= 161)
(3)
Flash exposure compensation / Flash
output level (= 87, = 94)
(4)
Metering method (= 72),
Shadow correction (= 76)
(5)
Drive mode (= 86), AEB
shooting (= 74), Focus
bracketing (= 80)
(6)
White balance (= 76), Mercury
lamp correction (= 53)
(30) ISO speed (= 73)
(31) Grid lines (= 96)
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
(32) Hybrid Auto mode (= 35)
(33) Zoom bar (= 33)
(34)
Auto (= 42)
(35) Wind filter (= 69)
(23) Date stamp (= 45)
(36) Time zone (= 146)
(24) DR correction (= 75)
(37) Image stabilization (= 90)
(25) AE lock (= 72), FE lock
(= 88)
(38) MF indicator (= 79)
(26) Shutter speed (= 92, = 93)
Before Use
(39) Exposure compensation level
(= 72)
] mode, indicates the number of shots available.
Battery Level
(30) (31)
(39)
(29) Exposure level (= 93)
(22) AF frame (= 82), Spot AE point
frame (= 72)
* In [
(23)
(24)
(10)
(27) Aperture value (= 93)
(28) Electronic level (= 54)
(38)
An on-screen icon or message indicates the battery charge level.
Display
Details
(7)
My Colors (= 77)
Sufficient charge
(8)
Eco mode (= 147)
(9)
Self-timer (= 44)
Slightly depleted, but sufficient
(10) Camera shake warning (= 36)
(11) Red-eye correction (= 52)
(12) IS mode icon (= 39)
(Blinking red)
[Charge the battery]
Nearly depleted—charge the battery
pack soon
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
Depleted—charge the battery pack
immediately
(13) Battery level (= 180)
(14) Still image compression (= 90),
Resolution (= 52)
(15) Recordable shots (= 197)*
(16) Movie quality (= 53)
180
(27) Image quality / Frame rate (movies)
(= 52, = 53, = 70),
Image editing (= 116)
Playback (Detailed Information Display)
(2) (3)
(4) (5)(6)(7)(8)(9) (10) (11)
(1)
(13)
(14)
(17) (18) (19) (20)
(23) (25)
(24) (26)
Movies (= 33, = 101)
(2)
Current image no. / Total no. of
images
(3)
Histogram (= 103)
(4)
Battery level (= 180)
(5)
Wi-Fi signal strength (= 138)
(6)
Image Sync (= 139)
(7)
Image editing (= 116), Movie
compression (= 121)
(8)
Favorites (= 115)
(9)
Protection (= 110)
(15)
(27) (29)
(30)
(31) File size
Basic Guide
(31)
(29) Compression (image quality)
(= 90) / Resolution (= 52,
= 53, = 70), Digest movies
(= 35), RAW (= 89), MP4
(movies)
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● Some information may not be displayed when viewing images on
a TV (= 157).
(28)
(15) Exposure compensation level
(= 72), Exposure shift level
(= 68)
(16) ISO speed (= 73), Playback
speed (= 63)
(17) Metering method (= 72)
(18) Flash (= 86), Flash exposure
compensation (= 87)
(19) White balance (= 76)
(20) White balance correction
(= 77), Mercury lamp
correction (= 53), Creative
Shot effect (= 58)
(21) My Colors (= 77, = 118)
(11) Shooting date/time (= 20)
(22) Focusing range (= 79)
(12) Shooting mode (= 182)
(23) Red-eye correction
(= 52, = 119)
(14) Aperture value (= 93),
Image quality (movies)
(= 52, = 53, = 70)
(16)
(21) (22)
(10) Folder number - File number
(= 149)
(13) Shutter speed (= 92, = 93)
Before Use
(28) Group playback (= 107)
(12)
(1)
(30) Still images: Resolution (= 197)
Movies: Playback time (= 198)
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
(24) High ISO NR (= 74)
(25) DR correction (= 75)
(26) Shadow correction (= 76),
i-Contrast (= 118)
181
Summary of Movie Control Panel
Before Use
Functions and Menu Tables
The following operations are available on the movie control panel
accessed as described in “Viewing” (= 101).
Exit
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
Functions Available in Each Shooting Mode
Play
Slow Motion (Press the [ ][ ] buttons to adjust the playback
speed. No sound is played.)
Skip Backward* or Previous Clip (= 121) (To continue skipping
backward, keep holding down the [ ] button.)
Previous Frame (For fast-rewind, keep holding down the [
button.)
Next Frame (For fast-forward, keep holding down the [
]
] button.)
Skip Forward* or Next Clip (= 121) (To continue skipping
forward, keep holding down the [ ] button.)
Edit (= 120)
Erase Clip (displayed when a digest movie is selected (= 121))
Shown when the camera is connected to a PictBridge-compatible
printer (= 166).
* Displays the frame approx. 4 sec. before or after the current frame.
Aperture Value
*1 /
/
/
/
*1 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Shutter Speed
*1 /
*1 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Program Shift (= 72)
*1 /
*1 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
1
* /
* /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
] button (= 85))
AF Lock (when assigned to the [
1
●● During movie playback, you can skip back or forward (or to the
previous or next clip) by pressing the [ ][ ] buttons.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Av/Tv Settings (= 92, = 93)
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
Move AF Frame (= 82)
*1 /
*1 /
/
/
/
/
/
Camera Basics
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Face Select (= 85)
*1 /
*1 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
182
Tracking AF (= 83)
* /
* /
/
/
/
/
/
1
1
/
/
Before Use
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Resize AF Frame (= 82)
*1 /
*1 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
2
/
* /
* /
/
/
/
/
/
1
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
*1 /
*1 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
*1 /
*1 /
/
/
/
/
/
*1 /
*1 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Basic Guide
/
Advanced Guide
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
*1 /
*1 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Flash (= 86)
Drive Mode (= 86)
*1 /
*1 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
AE Lock/FE Lock (= 68, = 72, = 88)*3
1
/
Focusing Range (= 79, = 85)
AE Lock (during recording)/Exposure Compensation (= 96)*
*1 /
*1 /
/
/
/
/
/
1
*4
Exposure Compensation (= 72)
*1 /
*1 /
/
/
/
/
/
* /
* /
/
/
/
/
/
1
/
/
/
*1 /
*1 /
/
/
/
/
/
*1 /
*1 /
/
/ *5 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
*5 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
*5 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
/
/
/
183
Shadow Correction (= 76)
1
1
* /
* /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Flash Exposure Compensation (= 87)
*1 /
*1 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
*1 /
*1 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
*1 /
*1 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
*5 Not available, but switches to [
/
/
/
] in some cases.
/
/
*1 /
*1 /
/
/
/
/
/
FUNC. Menu
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Basic Guide
/
/
/
Advanced Guide
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
White Balance (= 76)
DR Correction (= 75)
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
*1 /
*1 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
1
/
/
/
ISO Speed (= 73)
/
*1 /
*1 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
*1 /
*1 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
*1 Options vary depending on the assigned shooting mode.
*2 When assigned to the [ ] button (= 96).
*3 FE lock not available in [ ] flash mode.
], AF lock, or [ ].
*4[ ] is set with [
*1 /
*1 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Change Display (= 28)
*1 /
*1 /
/
/
/
/
/
Before Use
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
1
* /
* /
/
/
/
/
/
/
*1 /
*1 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
*1 /
*1 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
184
White Balance Correction (= 77)
1
1
* /
* /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Before Use
/
1
/
1
* /
* /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Advanced Guide
Self-Timer Settings (= 44)
My Colors (= 77)
Basic Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Delay*4
1
1
* /
* /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
*2 /
*1 /
*1 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
*3
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
1
* /
* /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Shots*5
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
*1 /
*1 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Metering Method (= 72)
Bracketing (= 74, = 80)
1
*1 /
*1 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
1
/
/
/
1
* /
* /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
*1 /
*1 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
*1 /
*1 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Still Image Aspect Ratio (= 51)
*1 /
*1 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
*1 /
*1 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
1
* /
* /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
/
Self-Timer (= 44)
1
Camera Basics
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
*1 /
*1 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
185
Movie Quality (= 53, = 70)
1
1
* /
* /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Resolution (= 52)
*1 /
*1 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Before Use
/
/
/
*1 /
*1 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
*1 /
*1 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Basic Guide
/
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
/
/
/
/
*1 /
*1 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
*1 /
*1 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
*1 /
*1 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
*6 /
/
/
/
*6 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Compression (= 90)
/
*1 /
*1 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
*1 /
*1 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Image Type (= 89)
/
/
1
* /
*1 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
*1 Options vary depending on the assigned shooting mode.
*2 White balance is not available.
*3 Set in a range of 1 – 5: contrast, sharpness, color saturation, red, green, blue,
and skin tone. Default: 3. These setting are applied in all modes.
*4 Cannot be set to 0 seconds in modes without selection of the number of shots.
*5 One shot (cannot be modified) in modes without selection of the number of
shots.
*6 Synchronizes with the aspect ratio setting and is automatically set (= 63).
186
AF-Point Zoom (= 54)
Shooting Tab
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
AF Frame (= 82)
Face Detect*1
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
*3 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
Standard
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
* /
* /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Basic Guide
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
*5 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
Off
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
1.6x/2.0x
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
2
* /
* /
/
/
/
/
/
Off
2
/
/
On
2
2
/
/
Continuous AF (= 84)
/
/
/
/
Off
Digital Zoom (= 40)
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
On
/
/
/
/
Servo AF (= 84)
FlexiZone/Center*4
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
Off
/
Tracking AF
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
Before Use
On
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
187
AF-assist Beam (= 55)
Recall Zoom/MF Settings (= 81)
On
Before Use
Zoom Memory
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Off
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Off
/
/
Basic Guide
On
/
/
/
/
/
MF-Point Zoom (= 79)
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
MF Memory
Off
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
On
/
/
/
/
/
/
2x/4x
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Off
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Safety MF (= 79)
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
MF Peaking Settings (= 80)
On
2
2
* /
* /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Peaking
/
/
/
On/Off
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
Off
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
Level
High/Low
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
188
Color
Before Use
2nd-curtain
Red/Yellow/Blue
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
2
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
* /
* /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Flash Control (= 52, = 55, = 87, = 88, = 94)
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
2
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
2
* /
* /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Red-Eye Lamp
On/Off
Flash Exp. Comp
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Safety FE
On
Flash Output
Minimum/Medium/Maximum
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
2
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
Off
1st-curtain
* /
* /
/
/
/
/
/
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
Shutter Sync.
2
/
/
Off
Manual
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
On
Auto
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Red-Eye Corr.
Flash Mode
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
2
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
189
ISO Auto Settings (= 74)
Safety Shift (= 93)
Max ISO Speed
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
2
* /
* /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
High ISO NR (= 74)
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Basic Guide
/
/
/
Advanced Guide
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
/
/
/
/
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Manual
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Spot AE Point (= 72)
2
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Disable
Center
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
2
* /
* /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
Level
0 – 47* – 63
AF Point
2
/
/
Auto
/
On/Off*
/
/
/
Sound rec.
/
Hg Lamp Corr. (= 53)
/
/
/
/
Sound rec. (= 68)
Low/Standard*/High
/
/
Off
/
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
Rate of Change
2
Before Use
On
2
* /
* /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
190
Wind filter/Attenuator
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
Off
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Basic Guide
/
/
/
Advanced Guide
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
On
/
/
/
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
Attenuator: On
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Blink Detection (= 55)
2
* /
* /
/
/
/
/
/
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
Attenuator: Off
2
/
Detailed
2
* /
* /
/
/
/
/
/
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
Wind Filter: Off
2
Before Use
Display Info
Wind Filter: Auto
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Off
/
/
/
/
Review image after shooting (= 56)
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Custom Display (= 96)
Display Time
Off
Shooting Info
2
2
* /
* /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
2
/
Quick
* /
* /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
2 sec./4 sec./8 sec./Hold
2
* /
* /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Electronic Level
/
/
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Index
Grid Lines
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
2
2
Camera Basics
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
191
Histogram
2
Before Use
2
2
* /
* /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
2
/
/
/
/
/
/
* /
* /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Large/Medium/Small*
/
/
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
Display Area (= 40)
FUNC. Menu Layout (= 97)
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
2
/
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
Reverse Disp. (= 20)
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Auto Settings (= 42, = 43)
On/Off
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Seek Assist
/
/
/
On
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
IS Settings (= 90)
IS Mode
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Off
Off
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
2
* /
* /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Face/Upper Body/Whole Body/Manual
/
/
/
Shoot Only
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
Auto Zoom
Continuous
2
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
Off
/
/
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
Camera Basics
/
Dynamic IS
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
1
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
192
Date Stamp (= 45)
Set
Off
button (= 96)
2
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
* /
* /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
2
* /
* /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
*1
*2
*3
*4
Date & Time
2
2
* /
* /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Before Use
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
Save Settings (= 98)
Date
2
2
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
/
/
/
Operation when no faces are detected varies by shooting mode.
Options vary depending on the assigned shooting mode.
Only available by pressing the [ ] button (= 72).
], [
], and [ ] modes, otherwise [Center].
[FlexiZone] in [ ], [
*5 [On] when subject movement is detected in [
] mode.
Digest Type (= 35)
Include Stills*/No Stills
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Face ID Settings (= 47)
On*/Off
2
2
* /
* /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
Set
/
/
/
/
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
Set Shortcut button (= 96)
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
Camera Basics
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
button (= 96)
*2 /
*2 /
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
193
Set Up Tab
Before Use
My Menu Tab
Basic Guide
Item
Ref. Page
Item
Ref. Page
Mute
= 145
My Menu settings
= 99
Volume
= 145
Hints & Tips
= 146
Date/Time
= 146
Time Zone
= 146
Lens Retraction
= 147
Eco Mode
= 147
Power Saving
= 26, = 147
LCD Brightness
= 148
Start-up Image
= 148
Format
= 148, = 149
File Numbering
= 149
Create Folder
= 150
Units
= 150
Electronic Level
= 150
Video System
= 157
Wi-Fi Settings
= 122
Mobile Device Connect Button
= 123
Copyright Info
= 151
Certification Logo Display
= 151
Language
= 152
Reset All
= 152
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Playback Tab
Item
Ref. Page
Image Search
= 105
List/Play Digest Movies
= 104
Smart Shuffle
= 110
Slideshow
= 109
Erase
= 112
Protect
= 110
Rotate
= 114
Favorites
= 115
Photobook Set-up
= 172
i-Contrast
= 118
Red-Eye Correction
= 119
Cropping
= 117
Resize
= 116
My Colors
= 118
Face ID Info
= 104
Transition Effect
= 101
Index Effect
= 105
Scroll Display
= 101
Group Images
= 107
Auto Rotate
= 115
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
194
Item
Ref. Page
Resume
= 101
Set Shortcut button
= 96
Print Tab
Handling Precautions
●● The camera is a high-precision electronic device. Avoid dropping it or
subjecting it to strong impact.
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
●● Never bring the camera near magnets, motors, or other devices that
generate strong electromagnetic fields, which may cause malfunction
or erase image data.
Item
Ref. Page
Print
–
Select Images & Qty.
= 171
Select Range
= 171
Select All Images
= 171
Clear All Selections
= 171
Print Settings
= 170
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● If water droplets or dirt adheres to the camera or screen, wipe with
a dry soft cloth, such as an eyeglass cloth. Do not rub hard or apply
force.
●● Never use cleaners containing organic solvents to clean the camera
or screen.
●● Use a blower brush to remove dust from the lens. If cleaning is difficult,
contact a Canon Customer Support Help Desk.
●● To prevent condensation from forming on the camera after sudden
temperature changes (when the camera is transferred from cold to
warm environments), put the camera in an airtight, resealable plastic
bag and let it gradually adjust to the temperature before removing it
from the bag.
●● If condensation does form on the camera, stop using it immediately.
Continuing to use the camera in this state may damage it. Remove
the battery pack and memory card, and wait until the moisture has
evaporated before resuming use.
●● Before long-term battery storage, use up the battery pack’s remaining
charge, remove it from the camera, and store it in a plastic bag
or similar container. Storing a partially charged battery pack over
extended periods (about a year) may shorten its life or affect
performance.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
195
Specifications
Camera Specifications
Wi-Fi
Before Use
Standards
IEEE 802.11b/g/n*
* 2.4 GHz band only
Basic Guide
Transmission
Methods
OFDM modulation (IEEE 802.11g/n)
DSSS modulation (IEEE 802.11b)
Advanced Guide
Infrastructure mode*1, Ad hoc mode*2
*1 Supports Wi-Fi Protected Setup
*2 Wi-Fi CERTIFIED IBSS
Camera Effective
Pixels (Max.)
Approx. 16.1 million pixels
Communication
Modes
Lens Focal
Length
65x zoom: 3.8 (W) – 247.0 (T) mm
(35mm film equivalent: 21 (W) – 1365 (T) mm)
Supported
Channels
1 – 11 (PC2188) or 1 – 13 (PC2154)
Model numbers indicated in parentheses
Viewfinder
LCD Viewfinder
Effective Pixels: Approx. 922,000 dots
Dioptric Adjustment Range: – 4.0 to +1.0 m-1 (dpt)
Security
WEP, WPA-PSK (AES/TKIP),
WPA2-PSK (AES/TKIP)
LCD Monitor
3.0-type color TFT LCD
Effective Pixels: Approx. 922,000 dots
File Format
Design rule for Camera File system, DPOF (version
1.1) compliant
Data Type
Still Images: Exif 2.3 (JPEG), RAW (CR2 (Canon
Original))
Movies: MP4 (Video: MPEG-4 AVC/H.264; Audio:
MPEG-4 AAC-LC (stereo))
Interface
Hi-speed USB
HDMI output
Analog audio output (stereo)
Analog video output (NTSC/PAL)
Power Source
Battery Pack NB-10L
AC Adapter Kit ACK-DC80
Dimensions
(Based on CIPA
Guidelines)
127.6 x 92.6 x 114.3 mm (5.02 x 3.65 x 4.50 in.)
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Digital Zoom Focal Length (35mm equivalent)
Digital Zoom [Standard]
21 – 5460 mm
(Represents the combined focal length
of optical and digital zoom.)
Digital Tele-Converter 1.6x
33.6 ‒ 2184.0 mm
Digital Tele-Converter 2.0x
42.0 ‒ 2730.0 mm
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
Approx. 650 g (approx. 22.93 oz.; including the
Weight (Based on
battery pack and memory card)
CIPA Guidelines)
Approx. 607 g (approx. 21.41 oz.; camera body only)
196
Number of Shots/Recording Time, Playback Time
Screen On
Approx. 340
Screen Off
Number of Shots
Viewfinder On
Approx. 340
Eco Mode On
Approx. 450
Screen On
Movie Recording
Screen Off
Time*1
Viewfinder On
Approx. 1 hour
Movie Recording Screen On
Time
Screen Off
(Continuous
Viewfinder On
Shooting*2)
Approx. 2 hours
Playback Time
Approx. 6 hours
Approx. 1 hour
Approx. 2 hours
*1Time under default camera settings, when normal operations are performed,
such as shooting, pausing, turning the camera on and off, and zooming.
*2Time available when shooting the maximum movie length (until recording stops
automatically) repeatedly.
●● The number of shots that can be taken is based on measurement
guidelines of the Camera & Imaging Products Association (CIPA).
●● Under some shooting conditions, the number of shots and recording
time may be less than mentioned above.
●● Number of shots/time with a fully charged battery pack.
Number of Shots per Memory Card
Before Use
The number of shots at an aspect ratio (= 51) of 4:3 per memory card
is as follows. Note that the number of shots available varies by aspect
ratio.
Recording Pixels
Compression
Ratio
Number of Shots per Memory
Card (Approx. shots)
8 GB
32 GB
(Large)
16M/
4608x3456
1058
4272
1705
6883
(Medium 1)
8M/
3264x2448
1996
8059
3069
12391
(Medium 2)
3M/2048x1536
4723
19064
8469
34184
(Small)
0.3M/640x480
27291
110150
40937
165225
317
1284
RAW Images
4608x3456
–
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● The values in the table are based on Canon measurement conditions
and may change depending on the subject, memory card and camera
settings.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
197
Recording Time per Memory Card
Shooting Range
Recording Time per Memory Card
Image Quality
8 GB
32 GB
Shooting
Mode
Focusing
Range
Before Use
Maximum Wide Angle
( )
Maximum Telephoto
( )
2 hr. 1 min. 27 sec.*2
–
0 cm (0.0 in.) – infinity
1.8 m (5.9 ft.) – infinity
43 min. 29 sec.
2 hr. 55 min. 43 sec.
–
1 m (3.3 ft.) – infinity
15 m (49 ft.) – infinity
2 hr. 3 min. 55 sec.
8 hr. 20 min. 32 sec.
5 cm (2.0 in.) – infinity
1.8 m (5.9 ft.) – infinity
5 hr. 14 min. 34 sec.
21 hr. 10 min. 38 sec.
0 – 50 cm
(0.0 in. – 1.6 ft.)
–
0 cm (0.0 in.) – infinity
1.8 m (5.9 ft.) – infinity
30 min. 3 sec.*1
*1 26 min. 22 sec. for iFrame movies (= 69).
*2 1 hr. 46 min. 33 sec. for iFrame movies (= 69).
●● The values in the table are based on Canon measurement conditions
and may change depending on the subject, memory card and camera
settings.
●● Recording will automatically stop when the clip file size reaches 4 GB,
or when the recording time reaches approximately 29 minutes and
59 seconds when shooting in [
], [
] or [
], or approximately
1 hour when shooting in [
].
●● Recording may stop even if the maximum clip length has not been
reached on some memory cards. SD Speed Class 6 or higher memory
cards are recommended.
Flash Range
Maximum wide angle (
Maximum telephoto (
)
)
Other
modes
*
*
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
* Not available in some shooting modes.
Continuous Shooting Speed
Continuous Shooting Mode
Speed
Approx. 6.4 shots/sec.
Approx. 3.8 shots/sec.
Approx. 4.6 shots/sec.
●● Using an 8 GB UHS-I memory card specified in Canon testing
standards. Note that the number of shots varies depending on
subjects, the brand of memory card, and other factors.
50 cm – 5.5 m (1.6 – 18 ft.)
1.8 m – 3.0 m (5.9 – 9.8 ft.)
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
198
Shutter Speed
Battery Charger CB-2LC/CB-2LCE
[
] mode,
automatically set
range
1 – 1/2000 sec.
Available values in
[
], [ ], or [ ]
mode (sec.)*
15, 13, 10, 8, 6, 5, 4, 3.2, 2.5, 2, 1.6, 1.3, 1, 0.8,
0.6, 0.5, 0.4, 0.3, 1/4, 1/5, 1/6, 1/8, 1/10, 1/13,
1/15, 1/20, 1/25, 1/30, 1/40, 1/50, 1/60, 1/80,
1/100, 1/125, 1/160, 1/200, 1/250, 1/320, 1/400,
1/500, 1/640, 1/800, 1/1000, 1/1250, 1/1600,
1/2000
* In [
] mode, shutter speeds of 1/25 seconds or slower are not available.
Aperture
f/number
f/3.4 / f/8.0 (W) – f/6.5 / f/8.0 (T)
Available values in
[
], [ ], or [ ]
mode*
f/3.5, f/4.0, f/4.3, f/4.5, f/5.0, f/5.6, f/6.3, f/6.5,
f/7.1, f/8.0
Rated Input: 100 – 240 V AC (50/60 Hz)
16 VA (100 V) – 22 VA (240 V), 0.18 A (100 V) –
0.12 A (240 V)
Rated Output: 8.4 V DC, 0.7 A
Charging Time: Approx. 1 hr. 50 min. (when using NB-10L)
Charge Indicator: Charging: orange / Fully charged: green (twoindicator system)
Operating Temperatures: 5 – 40 °C (41 – 104 °F)
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Lens Hood LH-DC90
Camera Mount: Bayonet
Max. Diameter x Length: ɸ70.0 x 27.7 mm (ɸ2.76 x 1.09 in.)
Weight: Approx. 9 g (approx. 0.32 oz.)
* Depending on the zoom position, some aperture values may not be available.
Battery Pack NB-10L
Type: Rechargeable lithium-ion battery
Nominal Voltage: 7.4 V DC
Nominal Capacity: 920 mAh
Charging Cycles: Approx. 300 times
Operating Temperatures: 0 – 40 °C (32 – 104 °F)
Dimensions: 32.5 x 45.4 x 15.1 mm (1.28 x 1.79 x 0.59 in.)
Weight: Approx. 41 g (approx. 1.45 oz.)
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
199
Index
A
AC adapter kit 155, 158
Accessories 155
AEB shooting 74
AE lock 72
AF frames 82
AF lock 85
Aspect ratio 51
Attenuator 69
AUTO mode (shooting mode) 22, 33
Av (shooting mode) 93
AV cable 158
CANON iMAGE GATEWAY 133
Center (AF frame mode) 82
Clock 32
Color (white balance) 76
Compression ratio (image quality) 90
Connecting via an access point 129
Creative filters (shooting mode) 60
Creative Shot 57
Cropping 117, 168
Custom white balance 77
D
Batteries
→ Date/time (date/time battery)
Power saving 26
Battery charger 2, 155
Battery pack
Charging 18
Eco mode 147
Level 180
Power saving 26
Black and white images 77
Blink detection 55
Date/time
Adding date stamps 45
Changing 21
Date/time battery 21
Settings 20
World clock 146
DC coupler 158
Defaults → Reset all
Digital tele-converter 81
Digital zoom 40
Display language 21
DPOF 170
Dynamic Range Correction 75
C
E
B
C1/C2 (shooting mode) 98
Camera
Reset all 152
Camera access point mode 132
CameraWindow (computer) 164
CameraWindow (smartphone) 123
Eco mode 147
Editing
Cropping 117
i-Contrast 118
My Colors 118
Red-eye correction 119
Resizing images 116
Editing or erasing connection
information 143
Electronic level 54
Erasing 112
Erasing all 114
Error messages 178
Exposure
AE lock 72
Compensation 72
FE lock 88
External microphone 159
F
Face detect (AF frame mode) 83
Face ID 47
Face select 85
Face self-timer (shooting mode) 66
Favorites 115
FE lock 88
File numbering 149
Fireworks (shooting mode) 59
Fish-eye effect (shooting mode) 62
Flash
Deactivating flash 87
Flash exposure compensation 87
On 86
Slow synchro 87
FlexiZone (AF frame mode) 82
Focus bracketing 80
Focusing
AF frames 82
AF lock 85
AF-point zoom 54
Face select 85
Focus memory 81
MF peaking 80
Servo AF 84
Focusing range
Macro 79
Manual focus 79
Focus lock 82
Framing Assist
Lock 41
Seek 40
Front dial 106
FUNC. menu
Basic operations 29
Table 184
FUNC. menu layout 97
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
G
Geotagging images 141
GPS information display 103
Grid lines 96
H
Handheld nightscene
(shooting mode) 59
HDMI cable 156, 157
High dynamic range
(shooting mode) 61
Household power 158
Hybrid Auto (shooting mode) 35
I
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
i-Contrast 75, 118
iFrame movies (movie mode) 69
Image quality
→ Compression ratio (image quality)
Images
Display period 56
Erasing 112
Playback → Viewing
Protecting 110
200
Image stabilization 90
Image Sync 139
Indicator 32, 55
ISO speed 73
J
Jump display 106
L
Low light (shooting mode) 59
M
M (shooting mode) 93
Macro (focusing range) 79
Magnified display 108
Manual focus (focusing range) 79
Manual (movie mode) 95
Memory cards 2
Recording time 198
Menu
Basic operations 30
Table 182
Mercury lamp correction 53
Metering method 72
Miniature effect (shooting mode) 62
Mobile device connection button 123
Monochrome (shooting mode) 64
Movies
Editing 120
Image quality (resolution/
frame rate) 53, 70
Recording time 198
Multi-area White Balance 53
My Colors 77, 118
N
P
P (shooting mode) 71
Package contents 2
Photobook set-up 172
PictBridge 156, 166
Playback → Viewing
Portrait (shooting mode) 59
Poster effect (shooting mode) 60
Power 155
→ Batteries
→ Battery charger
Power saving 26
Printing 166
Program AE 71
Protecting 110
R
RAW 89
Red-eye correction 52, 119
Remote shooting 142
Reset all 152
Resizing images 116
Resolution (image size) 52
Rotating 114
S
Saving images to a computer 165
Screen
Display language 21
Icons 180, 181
Menu → FUNC. menu, Menu
SD/SDHC/SDXC memory cards
→ Memory cards
Searching 105
Seek Assist 43
Self-timer 44
2-second self-timer 44
Customizing the self-timer 44
Face self-timer
(shooting mode) 66
Wink self-timer
(shooting mode) 65
Sending images 140
Sending images to another
camera 137
Sending images to a smartphone 123
Sending images to Web services 133
Sepia tone images 77
Servo AF 84
Shadow Correct 76
Shooting
Shooting date/time → Date/time
Shooting information 96, 180
Shortcut 96
Slideshow 109
Smart Shuffle 110
Smart Shutter (shooting mode) 65
Smile (shooting mode) 65
Snow (shooting mode) 59
Soft focus (shooting mode) 64
Software
Installation 127, 164
Saving images to
a computer 165
Sounds 145
Sports (shooting mode) 58
Stereo AV cable 155, 158
Strap 2
Super slow motion movie
(movie mode) 70
Super vivid (shooting mode) 60
T
Terminal 157, 158, 166
Toy camera effect
(shooting mode) 63
Tracking AF (AF frame mode) 83
Traveling with the camera 146
Troubleshooting 174
TV display 157
Tv (shooting mode) 92
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
V
Viewfinder 27
Viewing 24
Image search 105
Index display 105
Jump display 106
Magnified display 108
Single-image display 24
Slideshow 109
Smart Shuffle 110
TV display 157
W
White balance (color) 76
Wi-Fi functions 122
Wi-Fi menu 125
Wind filter 69
Wink self-timer (shooting mode) 65
World clock 146
Wrist strap → Strap
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
Z
Zoom 22, 33, 40, 81
Zoom framing assist 40
Neck strap → Strap
201
Wi-Fi (Wireless LAN) Precautions
●● Countries and Regions Permitting WLAN Use
-- Use of WLAN is restricted in some countries and regions, and illegal
use may be punishable under national or local regulations. To avoid
violating WLAN regulations, visit the Canon website to check where
use is allowed.
Note that Canon cannot be held liable for any problems arising from
use in other countries and regions.
●● Doing any of the following may incur legal penalties:
-- Altering or modifying the product
-- Removing the certification labels from the product
●● According to foreign exchange and foreign trade law regulations,
export permission (or service transaction permission) from the
Japanese government is necessary to export strategic resources or
services (including this product) outside Japan.
●● Because this product includes American encryption software, it falls
under U.S. Export Administration Regulations, and cannot be exported
to or brought into a country under U.S. trade embargo.
●● Be sure to make notes of the wireless LAN settings you use.
The wireless LAN settings saved to this product may change or be
erased due to incorrect operation of the product, the effects of radio
waves or static electricity, or accident or malfunction. Be sure to make
notes of wireless LAN settings as a precaution. Please note that
Canon accepts no responsibility for direct or indirect damages or loss
of earnings resulting from a degradation or disappearance of content.
●● When transferring this product to another person, disposing of it, or
sending it for repair, be sure to note the wireless LAN settings and
reset the product to its default settings (erase settings) if necessary.
●● Canon will not make compensation for damages resulting from loss or
theft of the product.
Canon accepts no responsibility for damages or loss resulting from
unauthorized access or use of target devices registered on this
product due to loss or theft of the product.
●● Be sure to use the product as directed in this guide.
Be sure to use the wireless LAN function of this product within the
guidelines noted in this guide. Canon accepts no responsibility for
damages or loss if the function and product are used in ways other
than as described in this guide.
●● Do not use the wireless LAN function of this product near medical
equipment or other electronic equipment.
Use of the wireless LAN function near medical equipment or other
electronic equipment may affect operation of those devices.
Before Use
Basic Guide
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Radio Wave Interference Precautions
●● This product may receive interference from other devices that emit
radio waves. To avoid interference, be sure to use this product as far
away as possible from such devices, or avoid using the devices at the
same time as this product.
Security Precautions
Because Wi-Fi uses radio waves to transmit signals, security precautions
more stringent than when using a LAN cable are required.
Keep the following points in mind when using Wi-Fi.
●● Only use networks you are authorized to use.
This product searches for Wi-Fi networks in the vicinity and displays
the results on the screen. Networks you are not authorized to use
(unknown networks) may also be displayed. However, attempting to
connect to or using such networks could be regarded as unauthorized
access. Be sure to use only networks you are authorized to use, and
do not attempt to connect to other unknown networks.
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
If security settings have not been properly set, the following problems may
occur.
●● Transmission monitoring
Third parties with malicious intent may monitor Wi-Fi transmissions
and attempt to acquire the data you are sending.
202
●● Unauthorized network access
Third parties with malicious intent may gain unauthorized access to
the network you are using to steal, modify, or destroy information.
Additionally, you could fall victim to other types of unauthorized access
such as impersonation (where someone assumes an identity to gain
access to unauthorized information) or springboard attacks (where
someone gains unauthorized access to your network as a springboard
to cover their tracks when infiltrating other systems).
To prevent these types of problems from occurring, be sure to thoroughly
secure your Wi-Fi network.
Only use this camera’s Wi-Fi function with a proper understanding of
Wi-Fi security, and balance risk and convenience when adjusting security
settings.
The camera can print to PictBridge-compatible printers
via Wi-Fi. PictBridge technical standards make it easy
to connect digital cameras, printers, and other devices
directly. Additionally, a new standard called DPS
over IP enables PictBridge connections in network
environments, and the camera is also compatible with
this standard.
Trademarks and Licensing
Before Use
●● Microsoft and Windows are trademarks or registered trademarks of
Microsoft Corporation in the United States and/or other countries.
Basic Guide
●● Macintosh and Mac OS are trademarks of Apple Inc., registered in the
U.S. and other countries.
Advanced Guide
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
●● App Store, iPhone, and iPad are trademarks of Apple Inc.
●● The SDXC logo is a trademark of SD-3C, LLC.
●● HDMI, the HDMI logo and High-Definition Multimedia Interface are
trademarks or registered trademarks of HDMI Licensing, LLC.
●● The iFrame logo and the iFrame symbol are trademarks of Apple Inc.
●● Wi-Fi , Wi-Fi Alliance , WPA™, WPA2™ and Wi-Fi Protected Setup™
are trademarks or registered trademarks of the Wi-Fi Alliance.
®
®
●● The N-Mark is a trademark or registered trademark of NFC Forum, Inc.
in the United States and in other countries.
●● All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners.
●● This device incorporates exFAT technology licensed from Microsoft.
●● This product is licensed under AT&T patents for the MPEG-4 standard
and may be used for encoding MPEG-4 compliant video and/or
decoding MPEG-4 compliant video that was encoded only (1) for
a personal and non-commercial purpose or (2) by a video provider
licensed under the AT&T patents to provide MPEG-4 compliant
video. No license is granted or implied for any other use for MPEG-4
standard.
Disclaimer
Camera Basics
Auto Mode /
Hybrid Auto Mode
Other Shooting Modes
P Mode
Tv, Av, M, C1, and C2 Mode
Playback Mode
Wi-Fi Functions
Setting Menu
Accessories
Appendix
Index
●● Unauthorized reproduction of this guide is prohibited.
●● All measurements based on Canon testing standards.
●● Information subject to change without notice, as are product
specifications and appearance.
●● Illustrations and screenshots in this guide may differ slightly from the
actual equipment.
●● The above items notwithstanding, Canon cannot be held liable for any
loss arising from the use of this product.
203
Was this manual useful for you? yes no
Thank you for your participation!

* Your assessment is very important for improving the work of artificial intelligence, which forms the content of this project

Download PDF

advertisement